blob: d45eb99d939294db6a77adbf24045b5969155623 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000077 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
78 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
84
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
88 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
89 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
175 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
176 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000177 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000182 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
183 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000185 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
186 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000189 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
190 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000191 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
192 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
195 Instruction *LHS,
196 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000197 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
198 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000199
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000200 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
201 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000202 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000203 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000204 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
205 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000206 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000207 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000210 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
213 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000214 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
215 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000217 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000218 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000219 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
220 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000221 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000222 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
223 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000224 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
225 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000226 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000227 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000228 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000229 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000230 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000231 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000232 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000233 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000234 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000235 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000236
237 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000238 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000239
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000240 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000241 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000242 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000243 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000244 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
245 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000246 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000247
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000248 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000249 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
250 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
251 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000252 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000253 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
254 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000255 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
256 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000257 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000258 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000259 }
260
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000261 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
262 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
263 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000264 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
265 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000266 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000267
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000268 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000269 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000270
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000271 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000272 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000273 return C;
274 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000275
276 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
277 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
278 }
279
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000280
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000281 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
282 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
283 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
284 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
285 // modified.
286 //
287 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000288 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000289 if (&I != V) {
290 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
291 return &I;
292 } else {
293 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
294 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000295 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000296 return &I;
297 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000298 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000299
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000300 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
301 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
302 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
303 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
304 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
305 //
306 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
307 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
308 if (Old != New)
309 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
310 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000311 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000312 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000313 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000314 return true;
315 }
316
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000317 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
318 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
319 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
320 // this function.
321 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
322 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
323 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000324 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000325 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000326 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
327 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000328
329 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
330 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
331 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
332 }
333
334 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
335 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
336 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
337 }
338 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
339 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
340 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000341
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000342 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000343 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
344 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
345 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
346 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000347 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
348 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000349 Instruction *InsertBefore);
350
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000351 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
352 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000353 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000354
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000355 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
356 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
357 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
358
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000359 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
360 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000361 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
362 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
363 unsigned Depth = 0);
364
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000365 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
366 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
367
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000368 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
369 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
370 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
371 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
372
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000373 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
374 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
375 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
376 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000377 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
378
379
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000380 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
381 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000382
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000383 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000385 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000386 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000387 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000388 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000389 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000390 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000391 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000393
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000394 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000395
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000396 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
397 unsigned CastOpc,
398 int &NumCastsRemoved);
399 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
400 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000401
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000402 };
403}
404
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000405char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
406static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
407X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
408
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000409// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000410// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000411static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
412 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
413 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000414 return 3;
415 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000416 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000417 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
418 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000419}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000420
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000421// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
422// it.
423static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000424 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000425}
426
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000427// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
428// though a va_arg area...
429static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000430 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
431 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
432 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000433 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000434 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000435}
436
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000437/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
438/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
439static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
440 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000441 return I->getOperand(0);
442 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000443 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000444 return CE->getOperand(0);
445 return 0;
446}
447
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000448/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
449/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000450static Instruction::CastOps
451isEliminableCastPair(
452 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
453 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
454 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
455 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
456) {
457
458 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
459 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000460
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000461 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
462 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
463 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000464
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000465 return Instruction::CastOps(
466 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
467 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000468}
469
470/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
471/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
472/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000473static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
474 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000475 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
476
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000477 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000478 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000479 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000480 return false;
481 return true;
482}
483
484/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
485/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
486/// casts that are known to not do anything...
487///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000488Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
489 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
491 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
492 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000493 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000494
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000495 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000496}
497
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000498// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
499// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000500//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000501// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
502// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
503// binary operators.
504//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000505// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
506// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000507//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000508bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000509 bool Changed = false;
510 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
511 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000512
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000513 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
514 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000515 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
516 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
517 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000518 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
519 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
520 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000521 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
522 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
523 return true;
524 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
525 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
526 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
527 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
528 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
529
530 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000531 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000532 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000533 Op1->getOperand(0),
534 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000535 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000536 I.setOperand(0, New);
537 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
538 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000539 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000540 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000541 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000542}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000543
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000544/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
545/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
546/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
547bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
548 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
549 return false;
550 I.swapOperands();
551 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
552 return true;
553}
554
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000555// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
556// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000557//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000558static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
559 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000560 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000561
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000562 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
563 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
564 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000565
566 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
567 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
568 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
569
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000570 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000571}
572
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000573static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
574 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000575 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000576
577 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000578 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000579 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000580 return 0;
581}
582
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000583// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
584// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000585// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
586// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000587//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000588static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000589 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000590 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000591 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000592 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000593 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000594 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000595 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000596 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000597 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000598 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000599 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000600 return I->getOperand(0);
601 }
602 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000603 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000604}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000605
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000606/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
607/// expression, return it.
608static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
609 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
610 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
611 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
612 return cast<User>(V);
613 return false;
614}
615
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000616/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
617/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000618static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
619 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000620 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000621 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000622 return CE->getOpcode();
623 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
624 return Instruction::UserOp1;
625}
626
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000627/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000628static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000629 APInt Val(C->getValue());
630 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000631}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000632/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000633static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000634 APInt Val(C->getValue());
635 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000636}
637/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
638static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
639 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
640}
641/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
642static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
643 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
644}
645/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
646static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
647 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
648}
649/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
650static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
651 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000652}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000653/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
654/// this size.
655static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
656 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
657 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
658 if (sign) {
659 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
660 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
661 } else {
662 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
663 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
664 }
665
666 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
667
668 if (sign) {
669 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
670 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
671 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
672 } else
673 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
674}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000675
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000676
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000677/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
678/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
679/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
680/// constant and return true.
681static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000682 APInt Demanded) {
683 assert(I && "No instruction?");
684 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
685
686 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
687 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
688 if (!OpC) return false;
689
690 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
691 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
692 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
693 return false;
694
695 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
696 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
697 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
698 return true;
699}
700
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000701// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
702// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
703// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
704// min/max.
705static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000706 const APInt& KnownZero,
707 const APInt& KnownOne,
708 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
709 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
710 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
711 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
712 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
713 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000714 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000715
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000716 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
717 // bit if it is unknown.
718 Min = KnownOne;
719 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
720
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000721 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000722 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
723 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000724 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000725}
726
727// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
728// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
729// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
730// min/max.
731static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000732 const APInt &KnownZero,
733 const APInt &KnownOne,
734 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
735 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000736 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
737 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
738 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
739 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000740 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000741
742 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
743 Min = KnownOne;
744 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
745 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
746}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000747
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000748/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
749/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
750/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
751/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
752/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
753/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
754/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
755/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
756/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
757/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
758/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
759/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
760/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
761/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
762/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
763bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
764 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
765 unsigned Depth) {
766 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
767 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
768 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
769 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
770 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
771 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
772 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
773 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
774 must have same BitWidth");
775 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
776 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
777 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
778 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
779 return false;
780 }
781
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000782 KnownZero.clear();
783 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000784 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
785 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
786 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
787 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
788 return false;
789 }
790 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
791 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
792 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
793 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
794 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
795 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
796 return false;
797 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
798 return false;
799 }
800
801 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
802 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
803
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000804 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
805 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
806 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000807 default:
808 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
809 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000810 case Instruction::And:
811 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
812 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
813 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
814 return true;
815 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
816 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
817
818 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
819 // LHS.
820 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
821 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
822 return true;
823 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
824 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
825
826 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
827 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
828 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
829 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
830 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
831 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
832 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
833 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
834
835 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
836 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
837 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
838
839 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
840 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
841 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
842
843 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
844 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
845 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
846 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
847 break;
848 case Instruction::Or:
849 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
850 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
851 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
852 return true;
853 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
854 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
855 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
856 // LHS.
857 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
858 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
859 return true;
860 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
861 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
862
863 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
864 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
865 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
866 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
867 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
868 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
869 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
870 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
871
872 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
873 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
874 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
875 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
876 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
877 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
878 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
879 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
880
881 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
882 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
883 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
884
885 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
886 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
887 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
888 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
889 break;
890 case Instruction::Xor: {
891 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
892 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
893 return true;
894 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
895 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
896 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
897 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
898 return true;
899 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
900 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
901
902 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
903 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
904 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
905 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
906 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
907 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
908
909 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
910 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
911 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
912 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
913 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
914 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
915
916 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
917 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
918 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
919 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
920 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000921 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000922 I->getName());
923 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
924 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
925 }
926
927 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
928 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
929 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
930 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
931 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
932 // all known
933 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
934 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
935 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000936 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000937 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
938 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
939 }
940 }
941
942 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
943 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
944 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
945 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
946
947 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
948 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
949 break;
950 }
951 case Instruction::Select:
952 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
953 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
954 return true;
955 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
956 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
957 return true;
958 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
959 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
960 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
961 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
962
963 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
964 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
965 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
966 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
967 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
968
969 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
970 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
971 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
972 break;
973 case Instruction::Trunc: {
974 uint32_t truncBf =
975 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000976 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
977 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
978 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
979 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
980 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000981 return true;
982 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
983 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
984 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
985 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
986 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
987 break;
988 }
989 case Instruction::BitCast:
990 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
991 return false;
992
993 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
994 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
995 return true;
996 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
997 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
998 break;
999 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1000 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1001 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001002 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001003
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001004 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1005 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001007 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1008 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001009 return true;
1010 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1011 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1012 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1013 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1014 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1015 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001016 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001017 break;
1018 }
1019 case Instruction::SExt: {
1020 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1021 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001022 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001023
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001024 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001025 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001026
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001027 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001028 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1029 // bit is demanded.
1030 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001031 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001032
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001033 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1035 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001036 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1037 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001038 return true;
1039 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1040 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1041 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1042 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1043 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1044
1045 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1046 // top bits of the result.
1047
1048 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1049 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001050 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001051 {
1052 // Convert to ZExt cast
1053 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1054 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001055 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001056 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001057 }
1058 break;
1059 }
1060 case Instruction::Add: {
1061 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1062 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1063 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001064 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001065
1066 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1067 // we can do.
1068 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1069 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1070 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1071 if (RHS->isZero())
1072 break;
1073
1074 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1075 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001076 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001077
1078 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1079 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1080 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1081 return true;
1082
1083 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1084 // the constant.
1085 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1086 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1087
1088 // Avoid excess work.
1089 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1090 break;
1091
1092 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1093 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1094 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001095 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001096 I->getName());
1097 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1098 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1099 }
1100
1101 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1102 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1103 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1104 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1105 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1106
1107 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1108 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1109 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001110 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1111 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001112
1113 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1114
1115 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1116 // other, and there is no input carry.
1117 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1118 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1119
1120 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1121 // is no input carry.
1122 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1123 } else {
1124 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1125 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001126 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001127 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1128 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001129 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001130 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1131 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1132 return true;
1133 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1134 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1135 return true;
1136 }
1137 }
1138 break;
1139 }
1140 case Instruction::Sub:
1141 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1142 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001143 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001144 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1145 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001146 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001147 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001148 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1149 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1150 return true;
1151 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1152 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1153 return true;
1154 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001155 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1156 // the known zeros and ones.
1157 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001158 break;
1159 case Instruction::Shl:
1160 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001161 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001162 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1163 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1165 return true;
1166 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1167 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1168 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1169 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1170 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001171 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001172 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001173 }
1174 break;
1175 case Instruction::LShr:
1176 // For a logical shift right
1177 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001178 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001179
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001181 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1182 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001183 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1184 return true;
1185 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1186 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001187 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1188 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001189 if (ShiftAmt) {
1190 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001191 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001192 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1193 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001194 }
1195 break;
1196 case Instruction::AShr:
1197 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1198 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1199 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1200 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1201 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1202 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001203 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001204 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1205 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1206 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1207 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001208
1209 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1210 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1211 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1212 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001213
1214 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001215 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001216
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001218 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001219 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1220 // demanded.
1221 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1222 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001223 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001224 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001225 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1226 return true;
1227 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1228 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1229 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001230 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001231 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1232 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1233
1234 // Handle the sign bits.
1235 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1236 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1237 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1238
1239 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1240 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001241 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001242 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1243 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001244 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1246 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1247 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1248 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1249 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001253 case Instruction::SRem:
1254 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1255 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
1256 if (RA.isPowerOf2() || (-RA).isPowerOf2()) {
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001257 APInt LowBits = RA.isStrictlyPositive() ? (RA - 1) : ~RA;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001258 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1259 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1260 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1261 return true;
1262
1263 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1264 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
1265 else if (LHSKnownOne[BitWidth-1])
1266 LHSKnownOne |= ~LowBits;
1267
1268 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
1269 KnownOne |= LHSKnownOne & DemandedMask;
1270
1271 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001275 case Instruction::URem: {
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001276 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1277 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001278 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
1279 APInt LowBits = (RA - 1);
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001280 APInt Mask2 = LowBits & DemandedMask;
1281 KnownZero |= ~LowBits & DemandedMask;
1282 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1283 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1284 return true;
1285
1286 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001287 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001288 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001289 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001290
1291 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1292 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001293 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1294 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1295 return true;
1296
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001297 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001298 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001299 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1300 return true;
1301
1302 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1303 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1304 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001305 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001306 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001307 case Instruction::Call:
1308 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1309 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1310 default: break;
1311 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1312 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1313 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1314 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1315 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1316
1317 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1318 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1319 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1320 NLZ &= ~7;
1321 NTZ &= ~7;
1322 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1323 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1324 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1325 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1326
1327 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1328 // the right place.
1329 Instruction *NewVal;
1330 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1331 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1332 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1333 else
1334 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1335 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1336 NewVal->takeName(I);
1337 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1338 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1339 }
1340
1341 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1342 break;
1343 }
1344 }
1345 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001346 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001347 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001348 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001349
1350 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1351 // constant.
1352 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1353 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1354 return false;
1355}
1356
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001357
1358/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1359/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1360/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1361/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1362///
1363/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1364/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1365/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1366Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1367 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1368 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001369 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001370 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1371 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1372 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1373 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1374
1375 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1376 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1377 UndefElts = EltMask;
1378 return 0;
1379 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1380 UndefElts = EltMask;
1381 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1382 }
1383
1384 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001385 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1386 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001387 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1388
1389 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1390 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1391 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1392 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1393 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1394 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1395 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1396 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1397 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1398 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1399 }
1400
1401 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001402 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001403 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1404 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001405 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001406 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001407 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001408 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1409 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1410 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1411 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1412 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1413 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001414 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001415 }
1416
1417 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1418 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1419 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1420 return false;
1421 }
1422 return false;
1423 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1424 return false;
1425 }
1426
1427 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1428 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1429
1430 bool MadeChange = false;
1431 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1432 Value *TmpV;
1433 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1434 default: break;
1435
1436 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1437 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1438 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001439 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001440 if (Idx == 0) {
1441 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1442 // which elt is getting updated.
1443 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1444 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1445 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1446 break;
1447 }
1448
1449 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1450 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001451 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001452 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1453 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1454
1455 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1456 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1457 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1458 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1459 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1460 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1461
1462 // The inserted element is defined.
1463 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1464 break;
1465 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001466 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001467 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001468 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1469 if (!VTy) break;
1470 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1471 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1472 unsigned Ratio;
1473
1474 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001475 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001476 // elements as are demanded of us.
1477 Ratio = 1;
1478 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1479 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1480 // Untested so far.
1481 break;
1482
1483 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1484 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1485 // elements are live.
1486 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1487 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1488 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1489 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1490 }
1491 } else {
1492 // Untested so far.
1493 break;
1494
1495 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1496 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1497 // live.
1498 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1499 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1500 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1501 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1502 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001503
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001504 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1505 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1506 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1507 if (TmpV) {
1508 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1509 MadeChange = true;
1510 }
1511
1512 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1513 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1514 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1515 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1516 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1517 // undef.
1518 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1519 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1520 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1521 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1522 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1523 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1524 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1525 // elements are undef.
1526 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1527 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1528 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1529 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1530 }
1531 break;
1532 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001533 case Instruction::And:
1534 case Instruction::Or:
1535 case Instruction::Xor:
1536 case Instruction::Add:
1537 case Instruction::Sub:
1538 case Instruction::Mul:
1539 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1540 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1541 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1542 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1543 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1544 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1545 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1546
1547 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1548 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1549 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1550 break;
1551
1552 case Instruction::Call: {
1553 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1554 if (!II) break;
1555 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1556 default: break;
1557
1558 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1559 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1560 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1561 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1562 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1563 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1564 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1565 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1566 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1567 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1568 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1569 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1570 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1571 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1572 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1573 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1574
1575 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1576 // scalarize it now.
1577 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1578 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1579 default: break;
1580 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1581 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1582 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1583 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1584 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1585 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1586 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1587 // Extract the element as scalars.
1588 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1589 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1590
1591 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1592 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1593 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1594 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001595 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001596 II->getName()), *II);
1597 break;
1598 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1599 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001600 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001601 II->getName()), *II);
1602 break;
1603 }
1604
1605 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001606 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1607 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001608 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1609 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1610 return New;
1611 }
1612 }
1613
1614 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1615 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1616 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1617 break;
1618 }
1619 break;
1620 }
1621 }
1622 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1623}
1624
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001625
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001626/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1627/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1628/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1629/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1630/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1631/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1632/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1633///
1634template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001635static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001636 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1637 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1638
1639 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1640 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1641 return F.apply(Root);
1642
1643 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1644 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001645 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001646 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1647 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1648
1649 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1650 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1651 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1652 ShouldApply = true;
1653 }
1654
1655 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1656 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1657 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001658 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1659 // and perform the reassociation.
1660 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1661
1662 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1663 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1664
1665 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1666 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001667 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001668 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1669 return 0;
1670 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001671 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001672 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001673 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001674 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001675 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001676
1677 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1678 // get to LHSI.
1679 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1680 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001681 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1682 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001683 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001684 ARI = NextLHSI;
1685
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001686 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1687 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1688 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1689 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1690 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001691
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001692 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1693 // the transformation...
1694 return F.apply(Root);
1695 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001696
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001697 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1698 }
1699 return 0;
1700}
1701
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001702namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001703
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001704// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001705struct AddRHS {
1706 Value *RHS;
1707 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1708 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1709 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001710 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1711 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001712 }
1713};
1714
1715// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1716// iff C1&C2 == 0
1717struct AddMaskingAnd {
1718 Constant *C2;
1719 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1720 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001721 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001722 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001723 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001724 }
1725 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001726 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001727 }
1728};
1729
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001730}
1731
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001732static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001733 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001734 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001735 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001736 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001737
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001738 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001739 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001740 }
1741
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001742 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001743 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1744 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001745
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001746 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1747 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001748 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1749 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001750 }
1751
1752 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1753 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1754 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1755 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001756 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001757 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001758 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001759 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001760 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001761 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001762 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001763 abort();
1764 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001765 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1766}
1767
1768// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1769// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1770// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1771// not have a second operand.
1772static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1773 InstCombiner *IC) {
1774 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1775 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1776 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1777 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1778
1779 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001780 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001781 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001782
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001783 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1784 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1785
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001786 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1787 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001788 }
1789 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001790}
1791
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001792
1793/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1794/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1795/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1796Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1797 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001798 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001799 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001800
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001801 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1802 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001803 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001804 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1805 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1806 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1807 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001808 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001809 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1810
1811 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1812 // loop.
1813 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1814 return 0;
1815 }
1816
1817 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1818 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1819 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1820 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1821 if (NonConstBB) {
1822 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1823 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1824 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001825
1826 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001827 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001828 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001829 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001830 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001831
1832 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1833 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1834 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001835 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001836 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001837 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001838 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1839 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1840 else
1841 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001842 } else {
1843 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1844 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001845 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001846 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1847 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001848 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001849 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001850 CI->getPredicate(),
1851 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1852 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001853 else
1854 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1855
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001856 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001857 }
1858 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001859 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001860 } else {
1861 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1862 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001863 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001864 Value *InV;
1865 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001866 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001867 } else {
1868 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001869 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001870 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1871 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001872 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001873 }
1874 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001875 }
1876 }
1877 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1878}
1879
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001880
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001881/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1882/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1883/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1884/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1885bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1886 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1887 // ones.
1888
1889 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1890 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1891 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1892 // sign extend fine.
1893 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1894 return true;
1895
1896
1897 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1898 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1899 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1900 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1901
1902 // TODO: Implement.
1903
1904 return false;
1905}
1906
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001907
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001908Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001909 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001910 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001911
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001912 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001913 // X + undef -> undef
1914 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1915 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1916
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001917 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001918 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001919 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1920 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001921 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001922 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1923 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001924 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001925 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001926
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001927 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001928 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001929 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001930 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001931 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001932 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001933
1934 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1935 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001936 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1937 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1938 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1939 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1940 return &I;
1941 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001942 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001943
1944 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1945 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1946 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001947
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001948 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1949 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001950 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1951 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001952 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001953 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001954
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001955 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001956 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1957 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001958 do {
1959 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001960 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1961 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001962 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1963 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001964 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001965 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1966 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001967 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001968 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001969 }
1970 }
1971 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001972 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1973 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1974 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001975
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001976 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00001977 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
1978 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
1979 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001980 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
1981 switch (Size) {
1982 default: break;
1983 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
1984 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
1985 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
1986 }
1987 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00001988 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001989 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001990 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001991 }
1992 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001993 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001994
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00001995 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
1996 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
1997
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00001998 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00001999 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002000 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002001
2002 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2003 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2004 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2006 }
2007 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2008 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2009 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2011 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002012 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002013
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002014 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002015 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2016 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002017 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2018 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002019 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002020 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002021 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002022 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002023 }
2024
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002025 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002026 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002027
2028 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002029 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2030 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002031 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002032
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002033
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002034 ConstantInt *C2;
2035 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2036 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002037 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002038
2039 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2040 ConstantInt *C1;
2041 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002042 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002043 }
2044
2045 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002046 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002047 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002048
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002049 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002050 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2051 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002052
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002053
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002054 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002055 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002056 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2057 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002058
2059 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2060 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2061 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2062 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2063 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2064 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2065 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2066 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2067 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2068 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2069
2070 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002071 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002072 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002073 }
2074 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002075
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002076 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002077 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002078 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2079 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2080 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2081 if (W != Y) {
2082 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002083 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002084 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002085 std::swap(W, X);
2086 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002087 std::swap(Y, Z);
2088 std::swap(W, X);
2089 }
2090 }
2091
2092 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002093 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002094 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002095 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002096 }
2097 }
2098 }
2099
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002100 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002101 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002102 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002103 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002104
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002105 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2106 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002107 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002108 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2109 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2110 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002111 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002112
2113 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002114 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002115
2116 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002117 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002118
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002119 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2120 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002121 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002122 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002123 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002124 }
2125 }
2126 }
2127
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002128 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2129 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002130 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002131 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002132 }
2133
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002134 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002135 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002136 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002137 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2138 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002139 if (!CI) {
2140 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2141 Other = LHS;
2142 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002143 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002144 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2145 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002146 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002147 unsigned AS =
2148 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002149 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2150 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002151 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002152 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002153 }
2154 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002155
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002156 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002157 {
2158 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2159 Value *Other = RHS;
2160 if (!SI) {
2161 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2162 Other = LHS;
2163 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002164 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002165 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2166 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002167 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002168
2169 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2170 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002171 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2172 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002173 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002174 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2175 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002176 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002177 }
2178 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002179
2180 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2181 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2182 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2183 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002184
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002185 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2186 // integer add followed by a sext.
2187 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2188 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2189 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2190 Constant *CI =
2191 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2192 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2193 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2194 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2195 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2196 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2197 CI, "addconv");
2198 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2199 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2200 }
2201 }
2202
2203 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2204 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2205 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2206 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2207 // integer add will not overflow.
2208 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2209 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2210 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2211 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2212 // Insert the new integer add.
2213 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2214 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2215 "addconv");
2216 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2217 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2218 }
2219 }
2220 }
2221
2222 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2223 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2224 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2225 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2226 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2227 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2228 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2229 // instcombined.
2230 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2231 Constant *CI =
2232 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2233 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2234 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2235 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2236 // Insert the new integer add.
2237 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2238 CI, "addconv");
2239 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2240 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2241 }
2242 }
2243
2244 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2245 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2246 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2247 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2248 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2249 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2250 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2251 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2252 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2253 // Insert the new integer add.
2254 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2255 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2256 "addconv");
2257 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2258 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2259 }
2260 }
2261 }
2262
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002263 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002264}
2265
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002266Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002267 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002268
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002269 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002271
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002272 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002273 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002274 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002275
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002276 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2277 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2278 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2279 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2280
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002281 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2282 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002283 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002284 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002285
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002286 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002287 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002288 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002289 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002290
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002291 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2292 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002293 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002294 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002295 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002296 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002297 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002298 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002299 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002300 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002301 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002302 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002303 }
2304 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002305 }
2306 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2307 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2308 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002309 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002310 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002311 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002312 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002313 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002314 }
2315 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002316 }
2317 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002318 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002319
2320 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2321 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002322 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002323 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002324
2325 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2326 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2327 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002328 }
2329
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002330 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2331 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2332
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002333 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2334 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002335 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002336 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002337 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002338 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002339 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002340 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2341 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2342 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002343 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002344 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2345 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002346 }
2347
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002348 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002349 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2350 // is not used by anyone else...
2351 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002352 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002353 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002354 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2355 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2356 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2357 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002358
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002359 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002360 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002361 }
2362
2363 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2364 //
2365 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2366 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2367 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2368
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002369 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002370 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2371 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002372 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002373
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002374 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002375 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002376 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002377 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002378 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002379 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002380 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2381
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002382 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002383 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002384 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002385 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002386 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002387 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002388
2389 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2390 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2391 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2392 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2393 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2394 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002395 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002396 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002397 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002398 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002399 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002400 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002401
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002402 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002403 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002404 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002405 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2406 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2407 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2408 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002409 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2410 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002411 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002412 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002413 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002414
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002415 ConstantInt *C1;
2416 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002417 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002418 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002419
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002420 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2421 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002422 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002423 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002424 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002425}
2426
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002427/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2428/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2429/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2430/// signed.
2431static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2432 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002433 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002434 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2435 TrueIfSigned = true;
2436 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002437 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2438 TrueIfSigned = true;
2439 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002440 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2441 TrueIfSigned = false;
2442 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002443 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2444 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2445 TrueIfSigned = true;
2446 return RHS->getValue() ==
2447 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2448 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2449 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2450 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002451 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002452 default:
2453 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002454 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002455}
2456
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002457Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002458 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002459 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002460
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002461 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2463
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002464 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002465 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2466 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002467
2468 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002469 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002470 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2471 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002472 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002473 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002474
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002475 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002476 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2477 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2478 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2479 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002480 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002481
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002482 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002483 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002484 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002485 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002486 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002487 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002488 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2489 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002490
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002491 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2492 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002493 // We need a better interface for long double here.
2494 if (Op1->getType() == Type::FloatTy || Op1->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
2495 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2496 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002497 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002498
2499 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2500 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002501 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002502 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002503 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002504 Op1, "tmp");
2505 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2506 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2507 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002508 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002509
2510 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002511
2512 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2513 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002514 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002515 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002516
2517 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2518 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2519 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002520 }
2521
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002522 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2523 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002524 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002525
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002526 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2527 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2528
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002529 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2530 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2531 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2532 // formed.
2533 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002534 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002535 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002536 BoolCast = CI;
2537 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002538 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002539 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002540 BoolCast = CI;
2541 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002542 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002543 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2544 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002545 bool TIS = false;
2546
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002547 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002548 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2549 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002550 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2551 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002552 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002553 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002554 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002555 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002556 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002557 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002558 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2559 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002560
2561 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2562 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002563 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002564 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2565 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002566 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2567 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2568 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2569 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2570 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002571
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002572 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002573 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002574 }
2575 }
2576 }
2577
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002578 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002579}
2580
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002581/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2582/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2583/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2584/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002585Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002586 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002587
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002588 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2589 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2590 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2591 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2592 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002594 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002595
2596 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002597 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002598 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002599
Chris Lattner25feae52008-01-28 00:58:18 +00002600 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2601 // This does not apply for fdiv.
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002602 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner25feae52008-01-28 00:58:18 +00002603 // [su]div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in
2604 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2605 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB).
2606 // If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2607 // simplified also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
2608 if (ConstantInt *ST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002609 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2610 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2611 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002612 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002613 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2614 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2615 else
2616 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2617 return &I;
2618 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002619
Chris Lattner25feae52008-01-28 00:58:18 +00002620 // Likewise for: [su]div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2621 if (ConstantInt *ST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002622 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2623 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2624 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002625 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002626 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2627 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2628 else
2629 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2630 return &I;
2631 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002632 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002633
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002634 return 0;
2635}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002636
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002637/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2638/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2639/// division instructions.
2640/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002641Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002642 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2643
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002644 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002645 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2646 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2647 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2648 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2650 }
2651
2652 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2653 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2654 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002655
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002656 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2657 return Common;
2658
2659 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2660 // div X, 1 == X
2661 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2663
2664 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2665 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2666 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2667 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002668 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2669 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2670 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002671 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002672 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002673 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002674
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002675 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002676 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2677 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2678 return R;
2679 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2680 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2681 return NV;
2682 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002683 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002684
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002685 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002686 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002687 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2688 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2689
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002690 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2691 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2692 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2693
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002694 return 0;
2695}
2696
2697Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2698 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2699
2700 // Handle the integer div common cases
2701 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2702 return Common;
2703
2704 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2705 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2706 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2707 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002708 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002709 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002710 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002711 }
2712
2713 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002714 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002715 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2716 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002717 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002718 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002719 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002720 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002721 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002722 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002723 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002724 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002725 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002726 }
2727 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002728 }
2729
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002730 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2731 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002732 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002733 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002734 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002735 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002736 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002737 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002738 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002739 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2740 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002741 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002742 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2743 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2744
2745 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2746 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002747 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002748 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2749 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002750
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002751 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002752 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002753 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002754 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002755 return 0;
2756}
2757
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002758Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2759 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2760
2761 // Handle the integer div common cases
2762 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2763 return Common;
2764
2765 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2766 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2767 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002768 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002769
2770 // -X/C -> X/-C
2771 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002772 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002773 }
2774
2775 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2776 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002777 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002778 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002779 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002780 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002781 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002782 }
2783 }
2784
2785 return 0;
2786}
2787
2788Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2789 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2790}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002791
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002792/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2793/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2794/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2795/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2796Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002797 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002798
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002799 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002800 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2801 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2803
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002804 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2805 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002808 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002809 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002811
2812 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2813 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2814 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2815 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2816 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2817 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2818 // simplified also.
2819 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2820 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2821 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2822 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002823 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002824 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2825 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2826 else
2827 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002828 return &I;
2829 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002830 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2831 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2832 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2833 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2834 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002835 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002836 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2837 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2838 else
2839 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2840 return &I;
2841 }
Chris Lattner11a49f22005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002842 }
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002843
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002844 return 0;
2845}
2846
2847/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2848/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2849/// remainder instructions.
2850/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2851Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2852 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2853
2854 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2855 return common;
2856
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002857 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002858 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2859 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2861
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002862 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2864
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002865 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2866 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2867 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2868 return R;
2869 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2870 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2871 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002872 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002873
2874 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2875 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2876 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2877 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2878 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2879 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002880 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002881 }
2882
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002883 return 0;
2884}
2885
2886Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2887 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2888
2889 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2890 return common;
2891
2892 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2893 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2894 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2895 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2896 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002897 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002898 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002899 }
2900
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002901 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002902 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2903 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2904 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002905 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002906 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002907 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002908 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002909 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002910 }
2911 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002912 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002913
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002914 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2915 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2916 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2917 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2918 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2919 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002920 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2921 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002922 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002923 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002924 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002925 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002926 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002927 }
2928 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002929 }
2930
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002931 return 0;
2932}
2933
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002934Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2935 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2936
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002937 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002938 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2939 return common;
2940
2941 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2942 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002943 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002944 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2945 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2946 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2947 return &I;
2948 }
2949
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002950 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002951 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002952 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
2953 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
2954 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2955 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002956 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002957 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002958 }
2959
2960 return 0;
2961}
2962
2963Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002964 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2965}
2966
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002967// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002968static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spencer3a2a9fb2007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002969 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002970 if (!isSigned)
2971 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
2972 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits)-1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002973}
2974
2975// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002976static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002977 if (!isSigned)
2978 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
2979
2980 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2981 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2982 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits)+1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002983}
2984
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002985// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2986// constant.
2987static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002988 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002989}
2990
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002991// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2992// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2993static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002994 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002995}
2996
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002997/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002998/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2999///
3000/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3001///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003002/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3003/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003004///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003005/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3006/// 0 A > B
3007/// 1 A == B
3008/// 2 A < B
3009///
3010/// <=> Value Definition
3011/// 000 0 Always false
3012/// 001 1 A > B
3013/// 010 2 A == B
3014/// 011 3 A >= B
3015/// 100 4 A < B
3016/// 101 5 A != B
3017/// 110 6 A <= B
3018/// 111 7 Always true
3019///
3020static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3021 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003022 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003023 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3024 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3025 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3026 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3027 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3028 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3029 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3030 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3031 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3032 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003033 // True -> 7
3034 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003035 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003036 return 0;
3037 }
3038}
3039
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003040/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3041/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003042/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003043/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
3044static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3045 switch (code) {
3046 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003047 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003048 case 1:
3049 if (sign)
3050 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3051 else
3052 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3053 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3054 case 3:
3055 if (sign)
3056 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3057 else
3058 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3059 case 4:
3060 if (sign)
3061 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3062 else
3063 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3064 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3065 case 6:
3066 if (sign)
3067 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3068 else
3069 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003070 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003071 }
3072}
3073
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003074static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3075 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3076 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3077 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3078 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3079 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3080}
3081
3082namespace {
3083// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3084struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003085 InstCombiner &IC;
3086 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003087 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3088 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3089 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3090 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003091 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003092 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3093 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003094 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3095 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003096 return false;
3097 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003098 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3099 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3100 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3101 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3102 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003103 }
3104
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003105 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003106 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003107 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003108 unsigned Code;
3109 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3110 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3111 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3112 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003113 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003114 }
3115
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003116 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3117 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3118
3119 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003120 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3121 return I;
3122 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3123 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3124 }
3125};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003126} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003127
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003128// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3129// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003130// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003131Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003132 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3133 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003134 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3135 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003136 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003137 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003138 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003139
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003140 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3141 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003142 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003143 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003144 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003145 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003146 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003147 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003148 }
3149 break;
3150 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003151 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3152 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003153
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003154 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3155 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003156 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003157 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003158 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003159 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003160 }
3161 break;
3162 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003163 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003164 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3165 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3166 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003167 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003168
3169 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003170 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003171 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3172 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3173 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003174 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003175
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003176 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3177 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3178 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3179 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3180 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3181 // no effect.
3182 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3183 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3184 return &TheAnd;
3185 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003186 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003187 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003188 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003189 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003190 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003191 }
3192 }
3193 }
3194 }
3195 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003196
3197 case Instruction::Shl: {
3198 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3199 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3200 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003201 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003202 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003203 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3204 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003205
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003206 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3207 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3209 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003210 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3211 return &TheAnd;
3212 }
3213 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003214 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003215 case Instruction::LShr:
3216 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003217 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3218 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3219 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3220 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003221 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003222 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003223 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3224 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003225
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003226 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3227 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003228 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3229 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3230 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3231 return &TheAnd;
3232 }
3233 break;
3234 }
3235 case Instruction::AShr:
3236 // Signed shr.
3237 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3238 // with an and.
3239 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003240 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003241 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003242 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3243 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003244 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003245 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003246 // Make the argument unsigned.
3247 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003248 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003249 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003250 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003251 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003252 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003253 }
3254 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003255 }
3256 return 0;
3257}
3258
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003259
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003260/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3261/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003262/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3263/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003264/// insert new instructions.
3265Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003266 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3267 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003268 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003269 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003270 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003271
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003272 if (Inside) {
3273 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003274 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003275
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003276 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003277 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003278 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003279 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3280 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3281 }
3282
3283 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3284 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003285 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003286 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003287 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3288 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003289 }
3290
3291 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003292 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003293
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003294 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003295 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003296 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003297 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3298 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3299 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3300 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003301
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003302 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3303 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3304 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003305 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003306 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003307 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3308 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003309}
3310
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003311// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3312// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3313// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3314// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003315static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003316 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003317 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3318 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003319
3320 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003321 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003322 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003323 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003324 return true;
3325}
3326
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003327/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3328/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3329/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003330///
3331/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3332/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3333/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3334///
3335/// return (A +/- B).
3336///
3337Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003338 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003339 Instruction &I) {
3340 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3341 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3342 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3343
3344 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3345
3346 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3347 default: return 0;
3348 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003349 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003350 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003351 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3352 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3353 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003354 break;
3355
3356 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3357 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3358 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003359 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003360 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003361 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003362 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003363 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003364 break;
3365 }
3366 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003367 return 0;
3368 case Instruction::Or:
3369 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003370 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003371 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3372 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003373 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003374 break;
3375 return 0;
3376 }
3377
3378 Instruction *New;
3379 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003380 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003381 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003382 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003383 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3384}
3385
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003386Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003387 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003388 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003389
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003390 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3391 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3392
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003393 // and X, X = X
3394 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003396
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003397 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003398 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003399 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003400 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3401 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3402 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003403 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003404 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003405 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003406 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003407 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003408 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003409 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3410 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003411 }
3412 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003413
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003414 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003415 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3416 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003417
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003418 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003419 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003420 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003421 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3422 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3423 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3424 case Instruction::Xor:
3425 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003426 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3427 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3428 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3429 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003430 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003431 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3432 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003433 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003434 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003435 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003436 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003437 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3438 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003439 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003440 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3441 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003442 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003443 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3444 }
3445 }
3446
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003447 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003448 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003449 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3450 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3451 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3452 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003453 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003454 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003455 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003456 break;
3457
3458 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003459 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3460 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3461 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3462 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003463 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003464 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003465 }
3466
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003467 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003468 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003469 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003470 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003471 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3472 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3473 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3474 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003475 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003476 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003477 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003478 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3479 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003480 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3481 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3482 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003483 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003484 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3485 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003486 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003487 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003488 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003489 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003490 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003491 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3492 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3493 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003494 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003495 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3496 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3497 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003498 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003499 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003500 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003501
3502 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3503 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003504 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003505 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003506 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3507 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3508 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003509 }
3510
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003511 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3512 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003513
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003514 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3515 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3516
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003517 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003518 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003519 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003520 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003521 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003522 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003523 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003524
3525 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003526 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3527 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003528 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3529 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003530
3531 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3532 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3533 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003534 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003535 }
3536 }
3537
3538 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003539 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3540 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003541
3542 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3543 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3544 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003545 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003546 }
3547 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003548
3549 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3550 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3551 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3552 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3553 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3554 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3555 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3556 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3557 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3558 }
3559 }
3560 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3561 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3562 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3563 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3564 std::swap(A, B);
3565 }
3566 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003567 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003568 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003569 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003570 }
3571 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003572 }
3573
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003574 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3575 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3576 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003577 return R;
3578
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003579 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3580 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003581 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3582 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3583 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3584 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3585 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3586 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3587 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3588 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003589 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3590
3591 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3592 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3593 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3594 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003595 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003596 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3597 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3598 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3599 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3600 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3601 else
3602 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3603
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003604 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3605 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003606 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003607 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3608 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3609 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3610 }
3611
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003612 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003613 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3614 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003615 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3616 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3617 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003618 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3619
3620 switch (LHSCC) {
3621 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003622 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003623 switch (RHSCC) {
3624 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003625 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3626 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3627 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003628 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003629 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3630 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3631 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3633 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003634 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003635 switch (RHSCC) {
3636 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003637 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3638 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3639 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3640 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3641 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3642 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3643 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3644 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3645 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3646 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3647 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003648 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003649 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3650 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003651 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003652 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003653 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3654 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003655 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3656 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003657 }
3658 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3659 }
3660 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003661 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003662 switch (RHSCC) {
3663 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003664 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003666 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003667 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3668 break;
3669 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3670 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003671 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003672 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3673 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003674 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003675 break;
3676 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003677 switch (RHSCC) {
3678 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003679 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3680 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003681 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003682 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3683 break;
3684 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3685 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003686 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003687 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3688 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003689 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003690 break;
3691 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3692 switch (RHSCC) {
3693 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman5c1f1722008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003694 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003695 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3697 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3698 break;
3699 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3700 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3701 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3702 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3703 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3704 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3705 true, I);
3706 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3707 break;
3708 }
3709 break;
3710 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3711 switch (RHSCC) {
3712 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003713 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003714 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3715 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3716 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3717 break;
3718 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3719 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3720 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3721 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3722 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3723 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3724 true, I);
3725 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3726 break;
3727 }
3728 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003729 }
3730 }
3731 }
3732
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003733 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003734 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3735 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3736 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3737 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003738 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003739 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003740 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3741 I.getType(), TD) &&
3742 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3743 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003744 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003745 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3746 I.getName());
3747 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003748 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003749 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003750 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003751
3752 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003753 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3754 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3755 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003756 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3757 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3758 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003759 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003760 SI1->getOperand(0),
3761 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003762 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003763 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003764 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003765 }
3766
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003767 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3768 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3769 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3770 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3771 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD)
3772 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3773 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3774 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3775 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003776 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003777 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3778 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3779 RHS->getOperand(0));
3780 }
3781 }
3782 }
3783
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003784 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003785}
3786
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003787/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3788/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3789/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003790static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003791 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3792 if (I == 0) return true;
3793
3794 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3795 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3796 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3797 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3798
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003799 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003800 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3801 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003802 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003803 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003804 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003805 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3806 return true;
3807
3808 unsigned DestNo;
3809 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3810 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3811 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3812 } else {
3813 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3814 DestNo = 0;
3815 }
3816
3817 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3818 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3819 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3820 return true;
3821 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3822 return false;
3823 }
3824
3825 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3826 // don't have this.
3827 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3828 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3829 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3830 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3831 return true;
3832 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3833
3834 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003835 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3836 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003837 return true;
3838
3839 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3840 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003841 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3842 return true;
3843 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003844 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003845 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003846 break;
3847 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3848 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3849
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003850 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003851 unsigned SrcByte;
3852 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3853 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3854 else
3855 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3856
3857 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3858 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3859 return true;
3860
3861 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3862 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3863 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3864 return true;
3865 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3866 return false;
3867}
3868
3869/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3870/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3871Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003872 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3873 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3874 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003875
3876 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3877 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003878 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003879 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003880
3881 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3882 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3883 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3884 return 0;
3885
3886 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3887 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3888 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3889
3890 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3891 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3892 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3893 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003894 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003895 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003896 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003897 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003898}
3899
3900
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003901Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003902 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003903 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003904
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003905 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003906 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003907
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003908 // or X, X = X
3909 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003911
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003912 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3913 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003914 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3915 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3916 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3917 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3918 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3919 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003920 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3921 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3922 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3923 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3924 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003925 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003926
3927
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003928
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003929 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003930 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003931 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003932 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3933 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003934 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003935 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003936 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003937 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003938 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003939 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003940
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003941 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3942 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003943 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003944 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003945 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003946 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003947 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003948 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003949
3950 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3951 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003952 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003953 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003954 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3955 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3956 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003957 }
3958
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003959 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3960 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003961
3962 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3963 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3964 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3965 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3966 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3967 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3968
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003969 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3970 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003971 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003972 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3973 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3974 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003975 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3976 return BSwap;
3977 }
3978
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003979 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3980 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003981 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003982 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003983 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3984 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003985 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003986 }
3987
3988 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3989 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003990 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003991 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003992 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3993 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003994 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003995 }
3996
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003997 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00003998 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003999 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4000 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004001 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4002 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4003 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4004 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4005 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4006 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4007 // replace with V+N.
4008 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4009 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4010 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4011 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4012 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4013 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4014 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4015 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4016 }
4017 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4018 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4019 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4020 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4021 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4022 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4023 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4024 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4025 }
4026 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004027 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004028 }
4029
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004030 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4031 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004032 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4033 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4034 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4035 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4036 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4037 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4038 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4039 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4040 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4041
4042 if (V1) {
4043 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004044 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4045 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004046 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004047 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004048 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004049
4050 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004051 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4052 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4053 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004054 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4055 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4056 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004057 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004058 SI1->getOperand(0),
4059 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004060 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004061 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004062 }
4063 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004064
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004065 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4066 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004068 } else {
4069 A = 0;
4070 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004071 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004072 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4073 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004074 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004075
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004076 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004077 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004078 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004079 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004080 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004081 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004082 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004083
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004084 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4085 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4086 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004087 return R;
4088
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004089 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4090 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004091 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4092 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4093 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4094 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4095 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4096 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4097 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4098 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004099 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4100 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4101 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004102 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004103 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004104 bool NeedsSwap;
4105 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004106 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004107 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004108 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004109
4110 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004111 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4112 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4113 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4114 }
4115
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004116 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004117 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4118 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004119 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4120 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004121 // equal.
4122 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4123
4124 switch (LHSCC) {
4125 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004126 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004127 switch (RHSCC) {
4128 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004129 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004130 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4131 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004132 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004133 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4134 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004135 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004136 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004137 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004138 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4139 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4140 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004141 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004142 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4143 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4144 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4146 }
4147 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004148 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004149 switch (RHSCC) {
4150 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004151 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4152 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4153 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004154 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004155 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4156 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4157 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004158 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004159 }
4160 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004161 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004162 switch (RHSCC) {
4163 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004164 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004165 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004166 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004167 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4168 // this can cause overflow.
4169 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4170 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004171 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4172 false, I);
4173 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4174 break;
4175 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4176 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004178 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4179 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004180 }
4181 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004182 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004183 switch (RHSCC) {
4184 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004185 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4186 break;
4187 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004188 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4189 // this can cause overflow.
4190 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4191 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004192 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4193 false, I);
4194 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4195 break;
4196 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4197 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4198 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4199 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4200 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004201 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004202 break;
4203 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4204 switch (RHSCC) {
4205 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4206 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4207 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4209 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4210 break;
4211 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4212 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004214 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4215 break;
4216 }
4217 break;
4218 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4219 switch (RHSCC) {
4220 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4221 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4222 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4223 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4224 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4225 break;
4226 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4227 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004228 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004229 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4230 break;
4231 }
4232 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004233 }
4234 }
4235 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004236
4237 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004238 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004239 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004240 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004241 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4242 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4243 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4244 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4245 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4246 // generated.
4247 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4248 I.getType(), TD) &&
4249 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4250 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004251 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004252 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4253 I.getName());
4254 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004255 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004256 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004257 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004258 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004259 }
4260
4261
4262 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4263 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4264 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4265 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004266 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4267 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004268 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4269 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4270 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4271 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004272 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4274
4275 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4276 // rest.
4277 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4278 RHS->getOperand(0));
4279 }
4280 }
4281 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004282
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004283 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004284}
4285
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004286namespace {
4287
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004288// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4289struct XorSelf {
4290 Value *RHS;
4291 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4292 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4293 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4294 return &Xor;
4295 }
4296};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004297
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004298}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004299
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004300Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004301 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004302 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004303
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004304 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4305 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4306 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4307 // idiom (misuse).
4308 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004309 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004310 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004311
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004312 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4313 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004314 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004315 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004316 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004317
4318 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4319 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004320 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4321 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4322 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4323 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4324 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4325 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004326 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4327 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004328 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004329
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004330 // Is this a ~ operation?
4331 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4332 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4333 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4334 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4335 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4336 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4337 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4338 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4339 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004340 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004341 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4342 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4343 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004344 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004345 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004346 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004347 }
4348 }
4349 }
4350 }
4351
4352
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004353 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004354 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4355 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4356 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004357 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4358 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004359
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004360 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4361 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4362 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4363 }
4364
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004365 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4366 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4367 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4368 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4369 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4370 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4371 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4372 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4373 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4374 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4375 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4376 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4377 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4378 }
4379 }
4380 }
4381 }
4382 }
4383
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004384 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004385 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004386 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4387 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004388 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4389 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004390 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004391 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004392 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004393
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004394 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004395 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004396 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004397 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004398 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004399 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004400 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004401 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004402 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004403 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004404 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4405 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004406 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004407
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004408 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004409 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4410 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004411 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004412 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4413 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4414 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004415 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004416 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4417 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004418 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004419 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4420 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4421 return &I;
4422 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004423 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004424 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004425 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004426
4427 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4428 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004429 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004430 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004431 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4432 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4433 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004434 }
4435
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004436 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004437 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004438 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004439
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004440 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004441 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004443
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004444
4445 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4446 if (Op1I) {
4447 Value *A, *B;
4448 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4449 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004450 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004451 I.swapOperands();
4452 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004453 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004454 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004455 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004456 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004457 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4458 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4460 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4461 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4462 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004463 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004464 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004465 std::swap(A, B);
4466 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004467 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004468 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4469 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4470 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004471 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004472 }
4473
4474 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4475 if (Op0I) {
4476 Value *A, *B;
4477 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4478 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4479 std::swap(A, B);
4480 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4481 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004482 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4483 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004484 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004485 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4486 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4487 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4488 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4489 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4490 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4491 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4492 std::swap(A, B);
4493 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004494 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004495 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004496 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4497 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004498 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004499 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004500 }
4501
4502 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4503 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4504 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4505 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4506 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4507 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004508 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004509 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4510 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004511 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004512 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4513 }
4514
4515 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4516 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4517 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4518 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4519 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4520 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004521 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004522 }
4523 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4524 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4525 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4526 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004527 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004528 }
4529
4530 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4531 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4532 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4533 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4534 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4535 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4536 if (A == C)
4537 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4538 else if (A == D)
4539 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4540 else if (B == C)
4541 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4542 else if (B == D)
4543 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4544
4545 if (X) {
4546 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004547 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4548 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004549 }
4550 }
4551 }
4552
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004553 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4554 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4555 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004556 return R;
4557
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004558 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004559 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004560 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004561 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4562 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004563 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004564 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004565 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4566 I.getType(), TD) &&
4567 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4568 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004569 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004570 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4571 I.getName());
4572 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004573 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004574 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004575 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004576 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004577
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004578 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004579}
4580
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004581/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4582/// overflowed for this type.
4583static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004584 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004585 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004586
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004587 if (IsSigned)
4588 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4589 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4590 else
4591 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4592 else
4593 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004594}
4595
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004596/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4597/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4598/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4599static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4600 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4601 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004602 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4603 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004604
4605 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004606 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004607 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004608
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004609 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
4610 ++i, ++GTI) {
4611 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004612 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004613 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4614 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4615
4616 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4617 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4618 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4619
4620 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4621 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004622 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004623 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004624 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004625 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4626 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4627 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004628 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004629
4630 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4631 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4632 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4633 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4634 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4635 else {
4636 // Emit an add instruction.
4637 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004638 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004639 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004640 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004641 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004642 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004643 // Convert to correct type.
4644 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4645 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4646 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4647 else
4648 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4649 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4650 }
4651 if (Size != 1) {
4652 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4653 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4654 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4655 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004656 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004657 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4658 }
4659
4660 // Emit an add instruction.
4661 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4662 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4663 cast<Constant>(Result));
4664 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004665 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004666 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004667 }
4668 return Result;
4669}
4670
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004671
4672/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
4673/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
4674/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
4675/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
4676/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
4677/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
4678/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
4679///
4680/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
4681///
4682static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
4683 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004684 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4685 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
4686
4687 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
4688 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
4689 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
4690 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
4691 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
4692 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
4693 int64_t Offset = 0;
4694 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4695 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
4696 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4697 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4698
4699 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4700 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4701 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4702 } else {
4703 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4704 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4705 }
4706 } else {
4707 // Found our variable index.
4708 break;
4709 }
4710 }
4711
4712 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
4713 // evaluate it the general way.
4714 if (i == e) return 0;
4715
4716 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
4717 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
4718 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
4719 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4720
4721 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
4722 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4723 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
4724 if (!CI) return 0;
4725
4726 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4727 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4728
4729 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4730 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4731 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4732 } else {
4733 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4734 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4735 }
4736 }
4737
4738 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
4739 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
4740 // the index.
4741 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
4742 if (Offset == 0) {
4743 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
4744 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
4745 // computation crosses zero.
4746 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
4747 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
4748 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4749 return VariableIdx;
4750 }
4751
4752 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
4753 // the pointer size, so get it.
4754 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
4755
4756 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
4757 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
4758
4759 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
4760 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
4761 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
4762 // multiple of the variable scale.
4763 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
4764 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
4765 return 0;
4766
4767 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
4768 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4769 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004770 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004771 true /*SExt*/,
4772 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4773 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004774 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004775}
4776
4777
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004778/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004779/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004780Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4781 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4782 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004783 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004784
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004785 // Look through bitcasts.
4786 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
4787 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004788
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004789 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4790 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004791 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004792 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
4793 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
4794 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4795
4796 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
4797 if (Offset == 0)
4798 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004799 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4800 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004801 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004802 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4803 // compare the base pointer.
4804 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4805 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004806 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004807 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004808 if (IndicesTheSame)
4809 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4810 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4811 IndicesTheSame = false;
4812 break;
4813 }
4814
4815 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4816 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004817 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4818 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004819
4820 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4821 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004822 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004823 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004824
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004825 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4826 bool AllZeros = true;
4827 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4828 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4829 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4830 AllZeros = false;
4831 break;
4832 }
4833 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004834 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4835 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004836
4837 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004838 AllZeros = true;
4839 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4840 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4841 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4842 AllZeros = false;
4843 break;
4844 }
4845 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004846 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004847
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004848 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4849 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4850 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4851 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4852 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4853 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004854 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4855 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004856 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004857 NumDifferences = 2;
4858 break;
4859 } else {
4860 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4861 DiffOperand = i;
4862 }
4863 }
4864
4865 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4866 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004867 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00004868 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004869
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004870 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004871 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4872 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004873 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4874 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004875 }
4876 }
4877
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004878 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004879 // the result to fold to a constant!
4880 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4881 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4882 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4883 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4884 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004885 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004886 }
4887 }
4888 return 0;
4889}
4890
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004891/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
4892///
4893Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
4894 Instruction *LHSI,
4895 Constant *RHSC) {
4896 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
4897 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
4898
4899 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
4900 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00004901 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004902 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
4903
4904 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
4905 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
4906 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
4907 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4908
4909 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
4910 if (isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI))
4911 ++InputSize;
4912
4913 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
4914 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
4915 return 0;
4916
4917 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
4918 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
4919 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
4920 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
4921
4922 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
4923 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4924 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
4925 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
4926 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ; break;
4927 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
4928 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; break;
4929 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
4930 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE; break;
4931 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
4932 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; break;
4933 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
4934 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE; break;
4935 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
4936 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; break;
4937 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
4938 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4939 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
4940 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4941 }
4942
4943 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
4944
4945 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
4946
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00004947 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004948 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
4949 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4950
4951 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
4952 // and large values.
4953 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
4954 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
4955 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
4956 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00004957 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
4958 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004959 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4960 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4961 }
4962
4963 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
4964 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
4965 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
4966 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
4967 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00004968 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
4969 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4971 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4972 }
4973
4974 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] but
4975 // it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by casting the FP
4976 // value to the integer value and back, checking for equality. Don't do this
4977 // for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
4978 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
4979 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
4980 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
4981 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
4982 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
4983 // zero at this point.
4984 switch (Pred) {
4985 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
4986 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
4987 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4988 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
4989 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4990 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4991 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
4992 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
4993 if (RHS.isNegative())
4994 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
4995 break;
4996 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4997 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
4998 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
4999 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5000 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5001 break;
5002 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5003 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5004 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5005 if (RHS.isNegative())
5006 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5007 break;
5008 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5009 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5010 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5011 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5012 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5013 break;
5014 }
5015 }
5016
5017 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5018 // comparison.
5019 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5020}
5021
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005022Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5023 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005024 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005025
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005026 // Fold trivial predicates.
5027 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5029 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5031
5032 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5033 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5034 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5035 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5036 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5037 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5038 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5039 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5040 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5041 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5042 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5043 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5044
5045 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5046 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5047 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5048 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5049 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5050 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5051 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5052 return &I;
5053
5054 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5055 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5056 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5057 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5058 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5059 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5060 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5061 return &I;
5062 }
5063 }
5064
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005065 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005066 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005067
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005068 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5069 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005070 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5071 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5072 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5073 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5074 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005075 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5076 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5077 // True if unordered.
5078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005079 }
5080 }
5081
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005082 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5083 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5084 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005085 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5086 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5087 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5088 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5089 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5090 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005091 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005092 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5093 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5094 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5095 return NV;
5096 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005097 case Instruction::Select:
5098 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5099 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5100 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5101 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5102 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5103 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5104 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5105 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5106 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5107 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5108 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5109 I.getName()), I);
5110 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5111 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5112 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5113 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5114 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5115 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5116 I.getName()), I);
5117 }
5118 }
5119
5120 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005121 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005122 break;
5123 }
5124 }
5125
5126 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5127}
5128
5129Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5130 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5131 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5132 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5133
5134 // icmp X, X
5135 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005136 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005137 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005138
5139 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005140 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005141
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005142 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005143 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005144 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5145 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5146 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005147 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005148 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005149 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005150
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005151 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005152 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005153 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5154 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
5155 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005156 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005157 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005158 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005159 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005160 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005161 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005162
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005163 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5164 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5165 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005166 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005167 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5168 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005169 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005170 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005171 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005172 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005173 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5174 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5175 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005176 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005177 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5178 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005179 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005180 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005181 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005182 }
5183 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005184 }
5185
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00005186 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5187 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005188 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005189 Value *A, *B;
5190
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005191 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5192 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5193 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5194 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5195 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005196 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005197
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005198 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5199 default: break;
5200 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
5201 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005203 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5204 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
5205 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5206 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00005207 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5208 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5209 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5210 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
5211
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005212 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005213
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005214 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5215 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005217 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5218 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5219 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5220 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5221 break;
5222
5223 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5224 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005225 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005226 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5227 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5228 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5229 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00005230
5231 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5232 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5233 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5234 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005235 break;
5236
5237 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5238 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005239 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005240 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5241 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5242 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5243 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5244 break;
5245
5246 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5247 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005249 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
5250 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
5251 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
5252 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5253 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005254
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005255 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5256 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005258 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
5259 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
5260 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
5261 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5262 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005263
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005264 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5265 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005266 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005267 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
5268 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
5269 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
5270 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5271 break;
5272
5273 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5274 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005275 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005276 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
5277 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
5278 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
5279 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5280 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005281 }
5282
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005283 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5284 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005285 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
5286 //
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00005287 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005288 default: break;
5289 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5290 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5291 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5292 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5293 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5294 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5295 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5296 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00005297 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005298
5299 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005300 // in the input. If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
5301 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
5302
5303 bool UnusedBit;
5304 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5305
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005306 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5307 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005308 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5309 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5310 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005311 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5312 return &I;
5313
5314 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
5315 // in.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005316 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005317 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5318 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00005319 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
5320 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005321 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005322 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
5323 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005324 } else {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005325 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
5326 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005327 }
5328 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5329 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5330 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005331 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005332 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005333 break;
5334 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005335 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005336 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005337 break;
5338 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005339 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005340 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00005341 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005342 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005343 break;
5344 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005345 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00005347 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005349 break;
5350 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005351 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005353 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005354 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005355 break;
5356 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005357 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00005359 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005361 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005362 }
5363 }
5364
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005365 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005366 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005367 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005368 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005369 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5370 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005371 }
5372
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005373 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005374 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5375 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5376 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005377 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5378 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005379 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005380 bool isAllZeros = true;
5381 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5382 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5383 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5384 isAllZeros = false;
5385 break;
5386 }
5387 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005388 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005389 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5390 }
5391 break;
5392
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005393 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005394 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5395 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5396 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5397 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5398 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5399 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005400 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005401 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005402 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5403 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5404 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5405 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5406 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5407 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5408 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005409 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5410 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5411 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5412 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5413 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005414 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5415 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005416 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5417 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5418 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5419 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5420 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005421 }
5422 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005423
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005424 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005425 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005426 break;
5427 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005428 case Instruction::Malloc:
5429 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5430 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5431 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5432 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5433 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005434 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005435 }
5436 break;
5437 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005438 }
5439
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005440 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005441 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005442 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005443 return NI;
5444 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005445 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5446 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005447 return NI;
5448
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005449 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005450 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5451 // now.
5452 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5453 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5454 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005455 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5456 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005457 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005458
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005459 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5460 // so eliminate it as well.
5461 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5462 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005463
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005464 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005465 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005466 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005467 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005468 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005469 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005470 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005471 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005472 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005473 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005474 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005475 }
5476
5477 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005478 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005479 // This comes up when you have code like
5480 // int X = A < B;
5481 // if (X) ...
5482 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005483 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5484 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005485 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005486 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005487 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005488
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005489 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5490 { Value *A, *B;
5491 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5492 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5493 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5494 }
5495
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005496 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005497 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005498
5499 // -x == -y --> x == y
5500 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5501 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5502 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5503
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005504 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5505 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5506 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5507 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5508 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5509 }
5510
5511 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5512 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5513 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5514 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5515 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005516 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005517 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005518 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5519 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5520 }
5521
5522 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5523 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5524 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5525 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5526 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5527 }
5528 }
5529
5530 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5531 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005532 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5533 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005534 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5535 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005536 }
5537 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005538 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005539 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5540 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005541 }
5542 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005543 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005544 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5545 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005546 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005547
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005548 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5549 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5550 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5551 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5552 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5553
5554 if (A == C) {
5555 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5556 } else if (A == D) {
5557 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5558 } else if (B == C) {
5559 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5560 } else if (B == D) {
5561 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5562 }
5563
5564 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005565 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5566 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005567 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5568 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5569 return &I;
5570 }
5571 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005572 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005573 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005574}
5575
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005576
5577/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5578/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5579Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5580 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5581 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5582 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5583
5584 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5585 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5586 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5587 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5588 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5589 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5590 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5591 // if it finds it.
5592 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5593 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5594 return 0;
5595 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005596 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005597
5598 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5599 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5600 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5601 // instead of computing a divide.
5602 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5603
5604 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5605 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5606 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5607 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5608 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5609
5610 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005611 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005612
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005613 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5614 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5615 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5616 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5617 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5618 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5619 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5620 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5621 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5622
5623
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005624 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005625 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005626 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005627 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5628 if (!HiOverflow)
5629 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005630 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005631 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005632 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005633 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5634 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005635 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005636 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5637 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5638 if (!HiOverflow)
5639 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005640 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005641 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005642 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5643 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005644 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005645 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005646 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005647 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005648 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005649 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005650 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005651 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5652 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005653 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5654 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5655 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5656 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005657 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005658 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5659 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005660 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005661 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005662 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5663 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005664 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005665 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005666 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005667 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5668 }
5669
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005670 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5671 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005672 }
5673
5674 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005675 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005676 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5677 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5678 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5679 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5680 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005681 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005682 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5683 else if (LoOverflow)
5684 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5685 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5686 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005687 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005688 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5689 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5691 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005692 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005693 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5694 else if (LoOverflow)
5695 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5696 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5697 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005698 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005699 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5700 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005701 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5702 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5703 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005704 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005705 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005706 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5707 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005708 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005709 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005710 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5712 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005713 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5714 else
5715 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5716 }
5717}
5718
5719
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005720/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5721///
5722Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5723 Instruction *LHSI,
5724 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5725 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5726
5727 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005728 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005729 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5730 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5731 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005732 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
5733 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005734 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5735
5736 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5737 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5738 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5739 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5740 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5741 return &ICI;
5742 }
5743
5744 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5745 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5746
5747 // If so, the new one isn't.
5748 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5749
5750 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5751 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5752 else
5753 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5754 }
5755 }
5756 break;
5757 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5758 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5759 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5760 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5761
5762 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5763 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5764 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5765 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5766 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5767 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5768 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5769 // bit would not work.
5770 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00005771 (ICI.isEquality() ||
5772 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005773 uint32_t BitWidth =
5774 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5775 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5776 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5777 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5778 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5779 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005780 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005781 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5782 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5783 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5784 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5785 }
5786 }
5787
5788 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5789 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5790 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5791 // access.
5792 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5793 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5794 Shift = 0;
5795
5796 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5797 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5798 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5799 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5800
5801 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5802 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5803 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5804 if (ShAmt) {
5805 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5806 if (!CanFold) {
5807 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5808 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5809 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5810 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5811
5812 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5813 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5814 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5815 CanFold = true;
5816 }
5817
5818 if (CanFold) {
5819 Constant *NewCst;
5820 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5821 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5822 else
5823 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5824
5825 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5826 // compared.
5827 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5828 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5829 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5830 // result is always true or false now.
5831 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5833 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5834 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5835 } else {
5836 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5837 Constant *NewAndCST;
5838 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5839 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5840 else
5841 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5842 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5843 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5844 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5845 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5846 return &ICI;
5847 }
5848 }
5849 }
5850
5851 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5852 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5853 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5854 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5855 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5856 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5857 // Compute C << Y.
5858 Value *NS;
5859 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005860 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005861 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5862 } else {
5863 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005864 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005865 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5866 }
5867 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5868
5869 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5870 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005871 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005872 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5873
5874 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5875 return &ICI;
5876 }
5877 }
5878 break;
5879
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005880 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5881 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5882 if (!ShAmt) break;
5883
5884 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5885
5886 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5887 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5888 // simplified.
5889 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5890 break;
5891
5892 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5893 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5894 // comparison cannot succeed.
5895 Constant *Comp =
5896 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5897 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5898 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5899 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5901 }
5902
5903 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5904 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5905 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5906 Constant *Mask =
5907 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005908
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005909 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005910 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005911 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5912 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5913 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5914 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005915 }
5916 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005917
5918 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5919 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5920 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5921 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5922 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5923 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5924 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5925 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005926 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005927 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5928 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5929
5930 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5931 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5932 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005933 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005934 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005935
5936 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005937 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005938 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005939 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005940 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005941
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005942 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5943 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5944 // simplified.
5945 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5946 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5947 break;
5948
5949 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005950
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005951 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5952 // comparison cannot succeed.
5953 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5954 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5955 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5956 else
5957 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5958
5959 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5960 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5961 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5962 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5963 }
5964
5965 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
5966 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
5967 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00005968 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5969 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005970 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
5971 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
5972 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
5973 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005974
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00005975 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005976 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5977 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5978 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005979
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005980 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005981 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005982 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5983 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5984 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5985 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005986 }
5987 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005988 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005989
5990 case Instruction::SDiv:
5991 case Instruction::UDiv:
5992 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5993 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5994 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
5995 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
5996 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
5997 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005998 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
5999 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6000 DivRHS))
6001 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006002 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006003
6004 case Instruction::Add:
6005 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6006
6007 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6008 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6009 if (!LHSC) break;
6010 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6011
6012 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6013 .subtract(LHSV);
6014
6015 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6016 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6017 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6018 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6019 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6020 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6021 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6022 }
6023 } else {
6024 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6025 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6026 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6027 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6028 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6029 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6030 }
6031 }
6032 }
6033 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006034 }
6035
6036 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6037 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6038 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6039
6040 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6041 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6042 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6043 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6044 case Instruction::SRem:
6045 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6046 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6047 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6048 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6049 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006050 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006051 BO->getName());
6052 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6053 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6054 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6055 }
6056 }
6057 break;
6058 case Instruction::Add:
6059 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6060 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6061 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6062 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6063 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6064 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6065 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6066 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6067 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6068
6069 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6070 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6071 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6072 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6073 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006074 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006075 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6076 Neg->takeName(BO);
6077 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6078 }
6079 }
6080 break;
6081 case Instruction::Xor:
6082 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6083 // the explicit xor.
6084 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6085 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6086 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6087
6088 // FALLTHROUGH
6089 case Instruction::Sub:
6090 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6091 if (RHSV == 0)
6092 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6093 BO->getOperand(1));
6094 break;
6095
6096 case Instruction::Or:
6097 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6098 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6099 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6100 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6101 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6102 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6103 isICMP_NE));
6104 }
6105 break;
6106
6107 case Instruction::And:
6108 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6109 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6110 // comparison can never succeed!
6111 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6112 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6113 isICMP_NE));
6114
6115 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6116 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6117 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6118 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6119 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6120
6121 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006122 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006123 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6124 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6125 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6126 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6127 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6128 }
6129
6130 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6131 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6132 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6133 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6134 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6135 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6136 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6137 }
6138 }
6139 default: break;
6140 }
6141 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6142 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6143 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6144 AddToWorkList(II);
6145 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6146 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6147 return &ICI;
6148 }
6149 }
6150 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006151 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6152 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006153 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6154 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6155 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6156 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6157 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6158 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6159 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6160 // smaller constant values.
6161 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6162 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6163 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6164 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6165 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6166 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6167 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6168 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6169 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6170 }
6171 }
6172 }
6173 }
6174 return 0;
6175}
6176
6177/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6178/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6179///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006180Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6181 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006182 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6183 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006184 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006185 Value *RHSCIOp;
6186
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006187 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6188 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6189 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6190 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6191 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6192 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6193 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006194 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006195 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6196 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6197 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6198 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006199 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006200 }
6201
6202 if (RHSOp)
6203 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6204 }
6205
6206 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6207 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006208 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6209 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006210 return 0;
6211
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006212 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6213 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006214
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006215 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006216 // Not an extension from the same type?
6217 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006218 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6219 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006220
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006221 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006222 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6223 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6224 return 0;
6225
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006226 // Deal with equality cases early.
6227 if (ICI.isEquality())
6228 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6229
6230 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6231 // signed comparison.
6232 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6233 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6234
6235 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6236 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006237 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006238
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006239 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6240 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6241 if (!CI)
6242 return 0;
6243
6244 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6245 // reextended to DestTy.
6246 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6247 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6248
6249 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6250 if (Res2 == CI) {
6251 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6252 // For example, we might have:
6253 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6254 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6255 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6256 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6257 // because %A may have negative value.
6258 //
6259 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
6260 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006261 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006262 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
6263 else
6264 return 0;
6265 }
6266
6267 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6268 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6269
6270 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6271 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6272 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006274 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006275 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006276
6277 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6278 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6279 Value *Result;
6280 if (isSignedCmp) {
6281 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006282 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006283 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006284 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006285 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006286 } else {
6287 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6288 if (isSignedExt) {
6289 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6290 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006291 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006292 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6293 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6294 } else {
6295 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006296 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006297 }
6298 }
6299
6300 // Finally, return the value computed.
6301 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
6302 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
6303 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
6304 } else {
6305 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6306 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6307 "ICmp should be folded!");
6308 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6309 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6310 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006311 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006312 }
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006313}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006314
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006315Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6316 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6317}
6318
6319Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6320 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6321}
6322
6323Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006324 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6325 return R;
6326
6327 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6328
6329 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6330 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6331 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6332 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6333
6334 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
6335 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
6336 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006337 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006338
6339 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006340}
6341
6342Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6343 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006344 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006345
6346 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6347 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006348 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006349 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006351
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006352 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6353 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006354 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006355 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006356 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6357 }
6358 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006359 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6361 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006362 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006363 }
6364
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006365 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6366 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6367 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006368 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006369 return R;
6370
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006371 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006372 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6373 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006374 return 0;
6375}
6376
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006377Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006378 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006379 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006380
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006381 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6382 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006383 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6384 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6385 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006386 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6387 return &I;
6388
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006389 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6390 // of a signed value.
6391 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006392 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006393 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006394 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6395 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006396 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006397 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006398 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006399 }
6400
6401 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6402 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6403 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6404 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006405 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006406 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6407
6408 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6409 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6410 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6411 return R;
6412 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6413 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6414 return NV;
6415
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006416 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6417 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6418 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6419 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6420 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6421 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6422 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6423 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6424 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6425 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6426 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6427 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006428 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006429 I.getName());
6430 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6431
6432 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6433 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6434 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6435 // other xforms later if dead.
6436 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6437 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6438 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6439
6440 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6441 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6442 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6443 // mask as appropriate.
6444 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6445 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6446 else {
6447 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6448 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6449 }
6450
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006451 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006452 TI->getName());
6453 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6454
6455 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6456 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6457 }
6458 }
6459
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006460 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006461 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6462 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6463 Value *V1, *V2;
6464 ConstantInt *CC;
6465 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006466 default: break;
6467 case Instruction::Add:
6468 case Instruction::And:
6469 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006470 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006471 // These operators commute.
6472 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006473 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6474 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006475 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006476 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006477 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006478 Op0BO->getName());
6479 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006480 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006481 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006482 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006483 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006484 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006485 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006486 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006487 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006488
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006489 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006490 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006491 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006492 match(Op0BOOp1,
6493 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006494 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6495 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006496 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006497 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6498 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006499 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6500 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006501 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006502 V1->getName()+".mask");
6503 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6504
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006505 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006506 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006507 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006508
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006509 // FALL THROUGH.
6510 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006511 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006512 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6513 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006514 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006515 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006516 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6517 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006518 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006519 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006520 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006521 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006522 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006523 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006524 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006525 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006526 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006527
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006528 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006529 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6530 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6531 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006532 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006533 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6534 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006535 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006536 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6537 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006538 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6539 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006540 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006541 V1->getName()+".mask");
6542 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6543
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006544 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006545 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006546
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006547 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006548 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006549 }
6550
6551
6552 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6553 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6554 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6555 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6556 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6557
6558 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006559 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006560 case Instruction::Add:
6561 isValid = isLeftShift;
6562 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006563 case Instruction::Or:
6564 case Instruction::Xor:
6565 highBitSet = false;
6566 break;
6567 case Instruction::And:
6568 highBitSet = true;
6569 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006570 }
6571
6572 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6573 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6574 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6575 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6576 // operation.
6577 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006578 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006579 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006580
6581 if (isValid) {
6582 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6583
6584 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006585 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006586 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006587 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006588
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006589 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006590 NewRHS);
6591 }
6592 }
6593 }
6594 }
6595
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006596 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006597 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6598 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6599 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006600
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006601 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006602 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006603 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6604 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006605 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6606 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6607 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006608
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006609 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006610 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6611 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006612
6613 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6614
6615 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006616 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006617 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006618 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6619 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6620 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6621 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006622 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006623 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6624 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6625 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6626 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006627 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006628 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6629
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006630 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006631 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006632 }
6633
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006634 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6635 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6636 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6637 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6638 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006639 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006640 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006641 }
6642 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6643 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006644 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006645 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006646 }
6647 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6648 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6649 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6650 // generators.
6651 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6652 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006653 case 1 :
6654 case 8 :
6655 case 16 :
6656 case 32 :
6657 case 64 :
6658 case 128:
6659 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6660 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006661 default: break;
6662 }
6663 if (SExtType) {
6664 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6665 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6666 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6667 }
6668 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6669 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006670 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006671
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006672 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006673 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6674 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6675 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006676 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006677 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006678 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6679
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006680 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006681 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006682 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006683
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006684 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006685 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6686 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6687 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006688 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006689 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006690
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006691 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006692 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006693 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006694
6695 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6696 } else {
6697 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006698 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006699
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006700 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006701 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6702 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6703 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6704 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006705 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006706 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6707 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6708
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006709 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006710 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006711 }
6712
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006713 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006714 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6715 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6716 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006717 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006718 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6719
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006720 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006721 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006722 }
6723
6724 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006725 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006726 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006727 return 0;
6728}
6729
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006730
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006731/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6732/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6733/// X*Scale+Offset.
6734///
6735static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006736 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006737 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006738 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006739 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006740 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006741 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006742 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
6743 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6744 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6745 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6746 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
6747 Offset = 0;
6748 return I->getOperand(0);
6749 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6750 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
6751 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
6752 Offset = 0;
6753 return I->getOperand(0);
6754 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6755 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6756 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6757 unsigned SubScale;
6758 Value *SubVal =
6759 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6760 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
6761 Scale = SubScale;
6762 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006763 }
6764 }
6765 }
6766
6767 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6768 Scale = 1;
6769 Offset = 0;
6770 return Val;
6771}
6772
6773
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006774/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6775/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006776Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006777 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006778 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006779
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006780 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6781 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006782
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006783 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6784 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6785 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6786 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6787 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6788
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006789 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006790 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006791 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006792 }
6793 }
6794
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006795 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6796 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6797 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6798 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006799
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006800 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6801 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006802 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6803
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006804 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6805 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6806 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6807 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6808
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006809 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
6810 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006811 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006812
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006813 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6814 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006815 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6816 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006817 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6818 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6819
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006820 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6821 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006822 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6823 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006824
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006825 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6826 Value *Amt = 0;
6827 if (Scale == 1) {
6828 Amt = NumElements;
6829 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006830 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006831 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6832 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006833 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006834 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006835 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006836 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006837 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006838 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006839 }
6840
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006841 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6842 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006843 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006844 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6845 }
6846
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006847 AllocationInst *New;
6848 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006849 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006850 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006851 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006852 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006853 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006854
6855 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6856 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6857 // die soon.
6858 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6859 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006860 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6861 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6862 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006863 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6864 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6865 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006866 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6867}
6868
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006869/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006870/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6871/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6872/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6873/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6874///
6875/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6876/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006877///
6878/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
6879/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
6880/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
6881/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
6882/// efficiently truncated.
6883///
6884/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
6885/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
6886/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00006887bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
6888 unsigned CastOpc,
6889 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006890 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6891 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6892 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006893
6894 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006895 if (!I) return false;
6896
6897 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006898
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006899 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6900 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6901 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6902 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6903 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6904 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6905 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6906 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006907 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006908 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6909 return true;
6910 }
6911 }
6912
6913 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6914 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6915 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6916
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006917 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006918 case Instruction::Add:
6919 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006920 case Instruction::And:
6921 case Instruction::Or:
6922 case Instruction::Xor:
6923 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006924 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6925 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6926 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6927 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006928
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00006929 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00006930 // A multiply can be truncated by truncating its operands.
6931 return Ty->getBitWidth() < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6932 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6933 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6934 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6935 NumCastsRemoved);
6936
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006937 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006938 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6939 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6940 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006941 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6942 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6943 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006944 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6945 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006946 }
6947 break;
6948 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006949 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6950 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6951 // already zeros.
6952 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006953 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6954 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6955 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006956 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006957 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6958 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006959 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6960 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006961 }
6962 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006963 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006964 case Instruction::ZExt:
6965 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006966 case Instruction::Trunc:
6967 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00006968 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
6969 // of casts in the input.
6970 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006971 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006972 break;
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006973
6974 case Instruction::PHI: {
6975 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
6976 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
6977 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
6978 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
6979 NumCastsRemoved))
6980 return false;
6981 return true;
6982 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006983 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006984 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6985 break;
6986 }
6987
6988 return false;
6989}
6990
6991/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6992/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6993/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006994Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006995 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006996 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006997 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006998
6999 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7000 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007001 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007002 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007003 case Instruction::Add:
7004 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007005 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007006 case Instruction::And:
7007 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007008 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007009 case Instruction::AShr:
7010 case Instruction::LShr:
7011 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007012 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007013 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007014 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007015 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007016 break;
7017 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007018 case Instruction::Trunc:
7019 case Instruction::ZExt:
7020 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007021 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007022 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7023 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007024 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7025 return I->getOperand(0);
7026
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007027 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007028 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007029 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007030 break;
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007031 case Instruction::PHI: {
7032 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7033 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7034 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7035 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7036 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7037 }
7038 Res = NPN;
7039 break;
7040 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007041 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007042 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7043 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7044 break;
7045 }
7046
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007047 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007048 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7049}
7050
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007051/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7052Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007053 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7054
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007055 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007056 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007057 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007058 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7059 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7060 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7061 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007062 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007063 }
7064 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007065
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007066 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007067 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7068 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7069 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007070
7071 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007072 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7073 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7074 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007075
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007076 return 0;
7077}
7078
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007079/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7080Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7081 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7082
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007083 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007084 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7085 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007086 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7087 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7088 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7089 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007090 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007091 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7092 return &CI;
7093 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007094
7095 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7096 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7097 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7098 // non-type-safe code.
7099 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7100 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7101 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7102 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7103 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7104
7105 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7106 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7107 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7108 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7109 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7110 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7111
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007112 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7113 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7114 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007115 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007116 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007117 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007118 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7119 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007120
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007121 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7122 if (Offset < 0) {
7123 --FirstIdx;
7124 Offset += TySize;
7125 assert(Offset >= 0);
7126 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007127 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007128 }
7129
7130 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007131
7132 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7133 while (Offset) {
7134 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7135 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007136 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7137 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7138 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007139
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007140 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7141 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7142 } else {
7143 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7144 Offset = 0;
7145 OrigBase = 0;
7146 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007147 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7148 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007149 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007150 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7151 Offset %= EltSize;
7152 } else {
7153 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7154 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007155 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7156 } else {
7157 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7158 Offset = 0;
7159 OrigBase = 0;
7160 }
7161 }
7162 if (OrigBase) {
7163 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7164 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7165 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007166 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7167 NewIndices.begin(),
7168 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007169 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7170 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7171
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007172 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7173 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7174 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7175 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7176 }
7177 }
7178 }
7179 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007180 }
7181
7182 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7183}
7184
7185
7186
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007187/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7188/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007189/// cases.
7190/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7191Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7192 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7193 return Result;
7194
7195 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7196 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7197 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007198 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7199 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007200
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007201 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7202 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007203 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7204 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007205 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7206 return &CI;
7207
7208 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7209 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007210 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7211 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007212 return 0;
7213
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007214 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007215 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007216 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7217 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007218 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007219 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007220 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7221 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7222 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7223 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007224 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007225 bool DoXForm;
7226 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7227 default:
7228 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7229 // get here because of the check above.
7230 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7231 case Instruction::Trunc:
7232 DoXForm = true;
7233 break;
7234 case Instruction::ZExt:
7235 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7236 break;
7237 case Instruction::SExt:
7238 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7239 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007240 }
7241
7242 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007243 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7244 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007245 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7246 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7247 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7248 case Instruction::Trunc:
7249 case Instruction::BitCast:
7250 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7251 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7252 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7253 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7254 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007255 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7256 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007257 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007258 }
7259 case Instruction::SExt:
7260 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007261 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007262 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7263 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007264 }
7265 }
7266 }
7267
7268 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7269 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7270
7271 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7272 case Instruction::Add:
7273 case Instruction::Mul:
7274 case Instruction::And:
7275 case Instruction::Or:
7276 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007277 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007278 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7279 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7280 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7281 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7282 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007283 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7284 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007285 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007286 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7287 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007288 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007289 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007290 }
7291 }
7292
7293 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7294 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7295 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007296 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007297 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007298 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007299 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007300 }
7301 break;
7302 case Instruction::SDiv:
7303 case Instruction::UDiv:
7304 case Instruction::SRem:
7305 case Instruction::URem:
7306 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7307 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7308 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7309 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7310 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007311 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7312 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007313 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7314 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7315 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7316 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007317 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007318 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7319 }
7320 }
7321 break;
7322
7323 case Instruction::Shl:
7324 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7325 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7326 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7327 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7328 // in the value.
7329 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7330 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007331 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7332 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7333 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007334 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007335 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007336 }
7337 break;
7338 case Instruction::AShr:
7339 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7340 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7341 // simplifications.
7342 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7343 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007344 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007345 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7346 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007347 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007348 }
7349 }
7350 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007351 }
7352 return 0;
7353}
7354
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007355Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007356 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7357 return Result;
7358
7359 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7360 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007361 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7362 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007363
7364 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7365 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7366 default: break;
7367 case Instruction::LShr:
7368 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7369 // are already zeros.
7370 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007371 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007372
7373 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007374 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007375 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7376 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007377 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7379
7380 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7381 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007382 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7383 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7384 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007385 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007386 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007387 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7388
7389 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7390 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7391 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007392 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007393 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7394
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007395 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007396 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007397 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007398 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007399 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7400 "tmp"), CI);
7401 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007402 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007403 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007404 }
7405 break;
7406 }
7407 }
7408
7409 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007410}
7411
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007412/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7413/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7414Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7415 bool DoXform) {
7416 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7417 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7418 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7419 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7420 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7421
7422 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7423 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7424 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7425 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7426 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7427
7428 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7429 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7430 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007431 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007432 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7433 CI);
7434 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007435 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007436 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7437
7438 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7439 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007440 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007441 In->getName()+".not"),
7442 CI);
7443 }
7444
7445 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7446 }
7447
7448
7449
7450 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7451 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7452 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7453 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7454 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7455 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7456 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7457 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7458 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7459 // This only works for EQ and NE
7460 ICI->isEquality()) {
7461 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7462 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7463 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7464 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7465 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7466
7467 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7468 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7469 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7470
7471 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7472 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7473 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7474 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7475 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7476 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7477 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7478 }
7479
7480 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7481 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7482 if (ShiftAmt) {
7483 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7484 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007485 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007486 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7487 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7488 }
7489
7490 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7491 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007492 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007493 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7494 }
7495
7496 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7498 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007499 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007500 }
7501 }
7502 }
7503
7504 return 0;
7505}
7506
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007507Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007508 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7509 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7510 return Result;
7511
7512 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7513
7514 // If this is a cast of a cast
7515 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007516 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7517 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7518 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7519 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7520 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7521 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007522 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7523 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7524 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007525 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
7526 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
7527 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007528 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007529 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007530 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007531 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007532 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
7533 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
7534 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
7535 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007536 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007537 }
7538 return And;
7539 }
7540 }
7541 }
7542
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007543 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
7544 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007545
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007546 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
7547 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7548 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
7549 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
7550 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
7551 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
7552 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
7553 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
7554 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
7555 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
7556 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007557 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007558 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007559 }
7560
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007561 return 0;
7562}
7563
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007564Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007565 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7566 return I;
7567
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007568 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7569
7570 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7571 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7572 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7573 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7574 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7575 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7576 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7577 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7578
7579 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7580 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7581 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7582 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7583 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7584 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7585 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007586 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007587 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007588 CI);
7589 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007590 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007591 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7592
7593 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007594 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007595 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7596
7597 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7598 }
7599 }
7600 }
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00007601
7602 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
7603 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
7604 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
7605 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
7606 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
7607 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
7608 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
7609 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
7610
7611 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
7612 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
7613 // bits, it is already ready.
7614 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
7615 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
7616 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
7617 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
7618 // bits, just sext from i32.
7619 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7620 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7621 } else {
7622 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
7623 // bits, just truncate to i32.
7624 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7625 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7626 }
7627 }
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007628
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007629 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007630}
7631
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007632/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
7633/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007634static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007635 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
7636 if (F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven) == APFloat::opOK)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007637 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007638 return 0;
7639}
7640
7641/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
7642/// through it until we get the source value.
7643static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
7644 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
7645 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
7646 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
7647
7648 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
7649 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
7650 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
7651 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
7652 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
7653 return V; // No constant folding of this.
7654 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007655 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007656 return V;
7657 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
7658 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007659 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007660 return V;
7661 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
7662 }
7663
7664 return V;
7665}
7666
7667Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
7668 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7669 return I;
7670
7671 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
7672 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
7673 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
7674 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
7675 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
7676 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
7677 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
7678 default: break;
7679 case Instruction::Add:
7680 case Instruction::Sub:
7681 case Instruction::Mul:
7682 case Instruction::FDiv:
7683 case Instruction::FRem:
7684 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
7685 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
7686 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
7687 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
7688 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
7689 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7690 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
7691 // the cast, do this xform.
7692 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
7693 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
7694 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
7695 CI.getType(), CI);
7696 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
7697 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007698 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007699 }
7700 }
7701 break;
7702 }
7703 }
7704 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007705}
7706
7707Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7708 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7709}
7710
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007711Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
7712 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X if the intermediate type has enough bits in its
7713 // mantissa to accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not
7714 // do this with i64->float->i64.
7715 if (UIToFPInst *SrcI = dyn_cast<UIToFPInst>(FI.getOperand(0)))
7716 if (SrcI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7717 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00007718 SrcI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007719 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, SrcI->getOperand(0));
7720
7721 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007722}
7723
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007724Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
7725 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X if the intermediate type has enough bits in its
7726 // mantissa to accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not
7727 // do this with i64->float->i64.
7728 if (SIToFPInst *SrcI = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(FI.getOperand(0)))
7729 if (SrcI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7730 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00007731 SrcI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007732 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, SrcI->getOperand(0));
7733
7734 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007735}
7736
7737Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7738 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7739}
7740
7741Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7742 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7743}
7744
7745Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007746 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007747}
7748
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007749Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
7750 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7751 return I;
7752
7753 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
7754 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
7755
7756 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
7757 ConstantInt *Cst;
7758 Value *X;
7759 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
7760 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7761 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
7762 // is a single-index GEP.
7763 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7764 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00007765 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007766
7767 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7768 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7769 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7770
7771 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7772 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7773 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007774 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007775 }
7776 }
7777 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
7778 // struct etc.
7779 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7780 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7781 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
7782 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
7783
7784 // Get the size of the pointee type.
7785 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
7786
7787 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7788 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7789 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7790
7791 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7792 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7793 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
7794
7795 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
7796 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007797 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007798 }
7799 }
7800 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007801}
7802
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007803Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007804 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7805 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7806 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7807 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7808 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7809
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007810 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007811 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7812 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007813 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7814 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7815 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007816 } else {
7817 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7818 return Result;
7819 }
7820
7821
7822 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7823 // be replaced by the operand.
7824 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7826
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007827 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007828 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7829 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7830 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7831
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00007832 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
7833 // required for changing types.
7834 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
7835 return 0;
7836
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007837 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7838 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7839 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7840 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7841 return V;
7842
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007843 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7844 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007845 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7846 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7847 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7848 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7849 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7850 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7851 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7852 ++NumZeros;
7853 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007854
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007855 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7856 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7857 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007858 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
7859 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007860 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007861 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007862
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007863 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7864 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7865 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7866 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007867 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7868 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007869 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7870 CastInst *Tmp;
7871 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7872 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7873 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7874 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7875 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7876 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7877 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007878 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7879 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7880 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7881 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007882 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7883 // know the vector types match #elts.
7884 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007885 }
7886 }
7887 }
7888 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007889 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007890}
7891
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007892/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7893/// %C = or %A, %B
7894/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7895/// into:
7896/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7897/// %D = or %A, %C
7898///
7899/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7900/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7901/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7902///
7903static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7904 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7905 case Instruction::Add:
7906 case Instruction::Mul:
7907 case Instruction::And:
7908 case Instruction::Or:
7909 case Instruction::Xor:
7910 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7911 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7912 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007913 case Instruction::LShr:
7914 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007915 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007916 default:
7917 return 0; // Cannot fold
7918 }
7919}
7920
7921/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
7922/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
7923static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
7924 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7925 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
7926 case Instruction::Add:
7927 case Instruction::Sub:
7928 case Instruction::Or:
7929 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007930 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007931 case Instruction::LShr:
7932 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007933 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007934 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00007935 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007936 case Instruction::Mul:
7937 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
7938 }
7939}
7940
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007941/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
7942/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
7943Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
7944 Instruction *FI) {
7945 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
7946 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
7947 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007948 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007949 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
7950 return 0;
7951 } else {
7952 return 0; // unknown unary op.
7953 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007954
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007955 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007956 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
7957 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007958 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007959 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007960 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007961 }
7962
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007963 // Only handle binary operators here.
7964 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007965 return 0;
7966
7967 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
7968 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
7969 bool MatchIsOpZero;
7970 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7971 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7972 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7973 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7974 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7975 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7976 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7977 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7978 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7979 MatchIsOpZero = false;
7980 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
7981 return 0;
7982 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7983 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7984 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7985 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7986 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7987 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7988 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7989 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7990 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7991 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7992 } else {
7993 return 0;
7994 }
7995
7996 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007997 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
7998 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007999 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8000
8001 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8002 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008003 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008004 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008005 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008006 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008007 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8008 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008009}
8010
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008011Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008012 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8013 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8014 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8015
8016 // select true, X, Y -> X
8017 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008018 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008019 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008020
8021 // select C, X, X -> X
8022 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8023 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8024
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008025 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8026 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8027 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8029 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8030 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8031 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8032 else
8033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8034 }
8035
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008036 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008037 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008038 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008039 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008040 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008041 } else {
8042 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8043 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008044 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008045 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008046 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008047 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008048 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008049 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008050 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008051 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008052 } else {
8053 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8054 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008055 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008056 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008057 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008058 }
8059 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008060
8061 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8062 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8063 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008064 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008065 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008066 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008067 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008068
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008069 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8070 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8071 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008072 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008073 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008074 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008075 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008076 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008077 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008078 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008079 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008080 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008081 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008082
8083 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008084
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008085 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008086
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008087 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008088 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008089 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008090 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008091 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008092 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008093 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008094 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008095 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008096 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008097 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008098 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8099
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008100 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8101 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8102 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008103 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8104 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008105 if (SRASize < SISize)
8106 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8107 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8108 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008109 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008110 }
8111 }
8112
8113
8114 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008115 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008116 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8117 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008118 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008119 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008120 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8121 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8122 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008123 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8124 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8125 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008126 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8127 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008128 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8129 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008130 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008131 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008132 Value *V = ICA;
8133 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008134 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008135 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8136 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8137 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008138 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008139 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008140
8141 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008142 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8143 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008144 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008145 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8146 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8147 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8148 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8149 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8150 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8151 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8152 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8153 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008154 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008155 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008156 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008157 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008158 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8159 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8160
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008161 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008162 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008163 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8164 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8165 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8166 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8167 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8168 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8169 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8170 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8171 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8172 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8173 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008174 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008175 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8176 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8177 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8178 }
8179 }
8180
8181 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
8182 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8183 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
8184 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8185 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8186 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8187 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8188 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8189 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8190 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8191
8192 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
8193 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8194 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8196 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8197 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00008198 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008199 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8200 }
8201 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008202
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008203 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8204 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8205 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008206 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8207
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008208 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8209 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8210 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8211 return IV;
8212
8213 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8214 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008215 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8216 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8217 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8218 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8219 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8220 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8221 }
8222
8223 if (AddOp) {
8224 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8225 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8226 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8227 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8228 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8229 }
8230
8231 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008232 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8233 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8234 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8235 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8236 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8237 } else {
8238 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008239 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008240 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008241
8242 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8243 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8244 if (AddOp != TI)
8245 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8246 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008247 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8248 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008249
8250 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008251 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008252 }
8253 }
8254 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008255
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008256 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008257 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008258 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8259 // transformation we are doing here.
8260 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8261 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8262 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8263 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8264 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8265 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8266 OpToFold = 1;
8267 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8268 OpToFold = 2;
8269 }
8270
8271 if (OpToFold) {
8272 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008273 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008274 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8275 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008276 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008277 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008278 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008279 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008280 else {
8281 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8282 }
8283 }
8284 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008285
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008286 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8287 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8288 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8289 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8290 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8291 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8292 OpToFold = 1;
8293 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8294 OpToFold = 2;
8295 }
8296
8297 if (OpToFold) {
8298 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008299 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008300 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8301 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008302 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008303 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008304 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008305 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008306 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008307 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008308 }
8309 }
8310 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008311
8312 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8313 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8314 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8315 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8316 return &SI;
8317 }
8318
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008319 return 0;
8320}
8321
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008322/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8323/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8324/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8325/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8326/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8327///
8328static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8329 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008330
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008331 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8332 if (!U) return Align;
8333
8334 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8335 default: break;
8336 case Instruction::BitCast:
8337 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8338 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008339 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8340 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008341 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008342 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8343 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008344 AllZeroOperands = false;
8345 break;
8346 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008347
8348 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8349 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008350 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008351 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008352 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008353 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008354 }
8355
8356 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8357 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8358 // of the global.
8359 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8360 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8361 Align = PrefAlign;
8362 }
8363 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8364 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8365 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8366 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8367 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8368 Align = PrefAlign;
8369 }
8370 }
8371
8372 return Align;
8373}
8374
8375/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8376/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8377/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8378/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8379unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8380 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8381 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8382 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8383 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8384 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8385 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8386 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8387 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8388
8389 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8390 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8391
8392 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
8393 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008394}
8395
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008396Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008397 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
8398 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008399 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
8400 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8401
8402 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
8403 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
8404 return MI;
8405 }
8406
8407 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
8408 // load/store.
8409 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
8410 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
8411
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008412 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
8413 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
8414 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
8415 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008416 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008417 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
8418
8419 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008420 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008421
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008422 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008423 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008424
8425 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
8426 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
8427 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
8428 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
8429 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
8430 // integer datatype.
8431 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
8432 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
8433 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
8434 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
8435 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008436 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008437 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
8438 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
8439 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
8440 else
8441 break;
8442 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
8443 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
8444 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
8445 else
8446 break;
8447 } else
8448 break;
8449 }
8450
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008451 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008452 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
8453 }
8454 }
8455
8456
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008457 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
8458 // infer, use it.
8459 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
8460 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
8461
8462 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
8463 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008464 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
8465 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
8466 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
8467
8468 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8469 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
8470 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008471}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008472
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008473Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
8474 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
8475 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
8476 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
8477 return MI;
8478 }
8479
8480 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
8481 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
8482 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
8483 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
8484 return 0;
8485 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
8486 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8487
8488 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
8489 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
8490
8491 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
8492 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
8493 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
8494
8495 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
8496 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
8497
8498 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
8499 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
8500
8501 // Extract the fill value and store.
8502 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
8503 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
8504 Alignment), *MI);
8505
8506 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8507 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
8508 return MI;
8509 }
8510
8511 return 0;
8512}
8513
8514
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008515/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
8516/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
8517/// the heavy lifting.
8518///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008519Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008520 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
8521 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
8522
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008523 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
8524 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008525 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008526 bool Changed = false;
8527
8528 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
8529 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
8530 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8531
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008532 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008533 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008534 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
8535 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
8536 // alignment is sufficient.
8537 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008538 }
8539
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008540 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
8541 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
8542 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008543 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008544 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
8545 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
8546 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008547 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
8548 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
8549 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00008550 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008551 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
8552 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008553 Changed = true;
8554 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00008555
8556 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
8557 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
8558 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008559 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008560
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008561 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
8562 // set, update the alignment.
8563 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008564 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
8565 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008566 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
8567 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
8568 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008569 }
8570
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008571 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008572 }
8573
8574 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
8575 default: break;
8576 case Intrinsic::bswap:
8577 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
8578 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
8579 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
8580 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
8581 break;
8582 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
8583 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
8584 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
8585 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
8586 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
8587 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8588 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8589 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8590 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
8591 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
8592 CI);
8593 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008594 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008595 break;
8596 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
8597 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
8598 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8599 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
8600 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8601 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
8602 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
8603 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
8604 }
8605 break;
8606 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
8607 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
8608 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
8609 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
8610 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8611 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8612 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8613 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
8614 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
8615 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
8616 }
8617 break;
8618
8619 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
8620 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
8621 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
8622 uint64_t UndefElts;
8623 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
8624 UndefElts)) {
8625 II->setOperand(1, V);
8626 return II;
8627 }
8628 break;
8629 }
8630
8631 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
8632 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
8633 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
8634 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008635
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008636 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
8637 bool AllEltsOk = true;
8638 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
8639 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
8640 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
8641 AllEltsOk = false;
8642 break;
8643 }
8644 }
8645
8646 if (AllEltsOk) {
8647 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
8648 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
8649 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
8650 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008651
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008652 // Only extract each element once.
8653 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
8654 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
8655
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008656 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008657 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
8658 continue;
8659 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
8660 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
8661
8662 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
8663 Instruction *Elt =
8664 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
8665 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
8666 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008667 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008668
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008669 // Insert this value into the result vector.
8670 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
8671 i, "tmp");
8672 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008673 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008674 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008675 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008676 }
8677 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008678
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008679 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
8680 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
8681 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
8682 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
8683 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
8684 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
8685 if (&*++BI == II)
8686 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008687 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008688 }
8689
8690 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
8691 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
8692 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
8693 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
8694 bool CannotRemove = false;
8695 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
8696 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
8697 CannotRemove = true;
8698 break;
8699 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00008700 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
8701 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
8702 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
8703 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
8704 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8705 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
8706 } else {
8707 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
8708 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00008709 CannotRemove = true;
8710 break;
8711 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008712 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008713 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008714
8715 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
8716 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
8717 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
8718 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8719 break;
8720 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008721 }
8722
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008723 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008724}
8725
8726// InvokeInst simplification
8727//
8728Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008729 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008730}
8731
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00008732/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
8733/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008734static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
8735 const CastInst * const CI,
8736 const TargetData * const TD,
8737 const int ix) {
8738 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
8739 return false;
8740
8741 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
8742 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
8743 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
8744 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, ParamAttr::ByVal))
8745 return true;
8746
8747 const Type* SrcTy =
8748 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
8749 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8750 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
8751 return false;
8752 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
8753 return false;
8754 return true;
8755}
8756
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008757// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
8758//
8759Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008760 bool Changed = false;
8761
8762 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
8763 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008764 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
8765
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008766 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008767
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008768 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
8769 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
8770 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
8771 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
8772 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008773 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008774 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
8775 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008776 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
8777 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
8778 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
8779 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
8780 return 0;
8781 }
8782
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008783 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
8784 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
8785 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
8786 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008787 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008788 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008789 CS.getInstruction());
8790
8791 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
8792 CS.getInstruction()->
8793 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
8794
8795 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
8796 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008797 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
8798 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008799 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008800 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
8801 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008802
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008803 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
8804 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
8805 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
8806 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
8807
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008808 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8809 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8810 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00008811 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008812 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
8813 // the call.
8814 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008815 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
8816 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
8817 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
8818 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
8819 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008820 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008821 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008822 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008823
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008824 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008825 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008826 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008827 Changed = true;
8828 }
8829
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008830 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008831}
8832
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008833// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
8834// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
8835//
8836bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
8837 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
8838 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008839 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
8840 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008841 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00008842 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008843 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008844 const PAListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getParamAttrs();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008845
8846 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
8847 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
8848 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
8849 //
8850 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
8851 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008852 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008853
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008854 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00008855 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
8856
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008857 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008858 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00008859 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008860 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
8861 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
8862 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00008863 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008864 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008865
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008866 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008867 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008868 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008869 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
8870
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008871 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8872 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008873 if (RAttrs & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00008874 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
8875 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008876
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008877 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
8878 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
8879 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
8880 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
8881 if (!Caller->use_empty())
8882 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
8883 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
8884 UI != E; ++UI)
8885 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
8886 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008887 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008888 return false;
8889 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008890
8891 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
8892 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008893
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008894 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
8895 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
8896 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008897 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008898
8899 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008900 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
8901
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008902 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1) & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
8903 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008904
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008905 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
8906 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008907 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008908 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
8909 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008910 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008911 }
8912
8913 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008914 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008915 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008916
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008917 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
8918 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008919 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008920 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
8921 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008922 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
8923 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008924 break;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008925 ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008926 if (PAttrs & ParamAttr::VarArgsIncompatible)
8927 return false;
8928 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008929
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008930 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
8931 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
8932 std::vector<Value*> Args;
8933 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008934 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008935 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
8936
8937 // Get any return attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008938 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008939
8940 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
8941 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008942 RAttrs &= ~ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008943
8944 // Add the new return attributes.
8945 if (RAttrs)
8946 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008947
8948 AI = CS.arg_begin();
8949 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8950 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
8951 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
8952 Args.push_back(*AI);
8953 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008954 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008955 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008956 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008957 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008958 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008959
8960 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008961 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008962 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008963 }
8964
8965 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
8966 // now...
8967 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
8968 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
8969
8970 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00008971 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008972 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00008973 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
8974 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008975 } else {
8976 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
8977 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8978 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
8979 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
8980 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008981 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
8982 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008983 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008984 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
8985 Args.push_back(Cast);
8986 } else {
8987 Args.push_back(*AI);
8988 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008989
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008990 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008991 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00008992 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
8993 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008994 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00008995 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008996
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008997 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008998 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008999
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009000 const PAListPtr &NewCallerPAL = PAListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009001
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009002 Instruction *NC;
9003 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009004 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009005 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9006 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009007 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009008 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009009 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009010 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9011 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009012 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9013 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009014 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009015 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009016 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009017 }
9018
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009019 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009020 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009021 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009022 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009023 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009024 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009025 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009026
9027 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9028 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9029 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009030 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009031 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9032 } else {
9033 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9034 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9035 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009036 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009037 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009038 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009039 }
9040 }
9041
9042 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9043 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009044 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009045 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009046 return true;
9047}
9048
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009049// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9050// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9051//
9052Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9053 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9054 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9055 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009056 const PAListPtr &Attrs = CS.getParamAttrs();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009057
9058 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9059 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009060 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(ParamAttr::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009061 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009062
9063 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9064 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9065
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009066 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009067 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9068 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9069
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009070 const PAListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getParamAttrs();
9071 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009072 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9073 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Dale Johannesen0d51e7e2008-02-19 21:38:47 +00009074 ParameterAttributes NestAttr = ParamAttr::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009075
9076 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9077 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9078 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009079 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009080 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9081 NestTy = *I;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009082 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009083 break;
9084 }
9085
9086 if (NestTy) {
9087 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9088 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9089 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9090
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009091 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
9092 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009093
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009094 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009095 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9096
9097 // Add any function result attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009098 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(0))
9099 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009100
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009101 {
9102 unsigned Idx = 1;
9103 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9104 do {
9105 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009106 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009107 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9108 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9109 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9110 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009111 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009112 }
9113
9114 if (I == E)
9115 break;
9116
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009117 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009118 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009119 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009120 NewAttrs.push_back
9121 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009122
9123 ++Idx, ++I;
9124 } while (1);
9125 }
9126
9127 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9128 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009129 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009130
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009131 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009132 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9133
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009134 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009135 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009136 {
9137 unsigned Idx = 1;
9138 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9139 E = FTy->param_end();
9140
9141 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009142 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9143 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009144 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009145
9146 if (I == E)
9147 break;
9148
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009149 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009150 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009151
9152 ++Idx, ++I;
9153 } while (1);
9154 }
9155
9156 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9157 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9158 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009159 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009160 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9161 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009162 const PAListPtr &NewPAL = PAListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009163
9164 Instruction *NewCaller;
9165 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009166 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9167 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9168 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9169 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009170 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009171 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009172 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009173 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9174 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009175 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9176 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9177 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9178 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009179 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009180 }
9181 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9182 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9183 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9184 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9185 return 0;
9186 }
9187 }
9188
9189 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9190 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9191 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9192 Constant *NewCallee =
9193 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9194 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9195 return CS.getInstruction();
9196}
9197
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009198/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9199/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9200/// and a single binop.
9201Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9202 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009203 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9204 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009205 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009206 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9207 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9208
9209 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9210 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009211
9212 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9213 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009214 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009215 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009216 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009217 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009218 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9219 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9220 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009221 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009222
9223 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9224 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9225 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9226 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9227 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009228
9229 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9230 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9231 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009232 }
9233
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009234 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9235
9236 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9237 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9238 // hide them behind a phi.
9239 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9240 return 0;
9241
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009242 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009243 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009244 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009245 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009246 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9247 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009248 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9249 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009250 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9251 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9252 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009253
9254 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009255 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9256 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009257 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9258 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009259 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9260 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9261 }
9262
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009263 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9264 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9265 if (NewLHS) {
9266 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9267 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9268 }
9269 if (NewRHS) {
9270 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9271 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9272 }
9273 }
9274
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009275 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009276 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009277 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009278 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009279 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009280 else {
9281 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009282 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009283 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009284}
9285
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009286/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9287/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9288/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9289/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009290///
9291/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9292/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9293/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009294static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9295 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9296
9297 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9298 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9299 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009300
9301 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9302 // profitable to do this xform.
9303 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9304 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9305 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9306 UI != E; ++UI) {
9307 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9308 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9309 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9310 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9311 }
9312 isAddressTaken = true;
9313 break;
9314 }
9315
9316 if (!isAddressTaken)
9317 return false;
9318 }
9319
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009320 return true;
9321}
9322
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009323
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009324// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9325// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9326// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9327Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9328 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9329
9330 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9331 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9332 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9333 // code size and simplifying code.
9334 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9335 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009336 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009337 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9338 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009339 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009340 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9341 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009342 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009343 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9344 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009345 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9346 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9347 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9348 // load and the PHI.
9349 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9350 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9351 return 0;
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009352 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009353 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009354 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9355 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9356 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009357 } else {
9358 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9359 }
9360
9361 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9362 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9363 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9364 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009365 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009366 return 0;
9367 if (CastSrcTy) {
9368 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9369 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009370 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009371 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9372 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009373 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9374 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9375 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9376 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009377
9378 // If the PHI is volatile and its block has multiple successors, sinking
9379 // it would remove a load of the volatile value from the path through the
9380 // other successor.
9381 if (isVolatile &&
9382 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9383 return 0;
9384
9385
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009386 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
9387 return 0;
9388 }
9389 }
9390
9391 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
9392 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009393 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
9394 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00009395 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009396
9397 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9398 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009399
9400 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009401 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9402 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9403 if (NewInVal != InVal)
9404 InVal = 0;
9405 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9406 }
9407
9408 Value *PhiVal;
9409 if (InVal) {
9410 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
9411 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
9412 PhiVal = InVal;
9413 delete NewPN;
9414 } else {
9415 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
9416 PhiVal = NewPN;
9417 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009418
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009419 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009420 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009421 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009422 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009423 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009424 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009425 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009426 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009427 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
9428
9429 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
9430 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
9431 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
9432 if (isVolatile)
9433 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
9434 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
9435
9436 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009437}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009438
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009439/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
9440/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009441static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
9442 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009443 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
9444 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
9445
9446 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009447 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009448 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00009449
9450 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9451 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
9452 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009453
9454 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
9455 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009456
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009457 return false;
9458}
9459
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009460/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
9461/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
9462/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9463static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
9464 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
9465 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
9466 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
9467 return true;
9468
9469 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9470 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
9471 return false;
9472
9473 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
9474 // the value.
9475 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9476 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
9477 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
9478 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9479 return false;
9480 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
9481 return false;
9482 }
9483
9484 return true;
9485}
9486
9487
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009488// PHINode simplification
9489//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009490Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00009491 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009492 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00009493
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009494 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
9495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
9496
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009497 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
9498 // reducing code size.
9499 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
9500 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
9501 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
9502 return Result;
9503
9504 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
9505 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
9506 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009507 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
9508 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
9509 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009510 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009511 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
9512 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
9513 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9514 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009515
9516 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
9517 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
9518 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
9519 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
9520 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
9521 // late.
9522 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
9523 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
9524 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
9525 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9526 }
9527 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009528
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009529 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
9530 // same value, for example:
9531 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9532 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
9533 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
9534 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
9535 {
9536 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
9537 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
9538 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
9539 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
9540 ++InValNo;
9541
9542 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
9543 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
9544
9545 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
9546 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
9547 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
9548 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
9549 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
9550 break;
9551 }
9552
9553 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
9554 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
9555 // the value.
9556 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
9557 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
9558 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
9560 }
9561 }
9562 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00009563 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009564}
9565
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009566static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
9567 Instruction *InsertPoint,
9568 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00009569 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9570 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009571 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
9572 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
9573 // used for address computation.
9574 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
9575 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
9576 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
9577 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009578}
9579
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009580
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009581Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009582 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00009583 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009584 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009585 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009587
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009588 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
9589 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
9590
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009591 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
9592 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
9593 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
9594
9595 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009596 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009597
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009598 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
9599 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009600
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009601 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009602 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
9603 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009604 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009605 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00009606 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
9607 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
9608 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
9609 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
9610 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
9611 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
9612 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009613 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009614 }
9615 }
9616 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009617 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
9618 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
9619 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
9620 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009621 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009622 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009623 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009624 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009625 MadeChange = true;
9626 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009627 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
9628 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009629 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009630 MadeChange = true;
9631 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009632 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009633 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009634 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009635 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
9636
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009637 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
9638 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
9639 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009640 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9641 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
9642 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
9643 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
9644 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
9645 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009646 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
9647 if (I != BCI) {
9648 I->takeName(BCI);
9649 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
9650 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
9651 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009652 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009653 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009654 }
9655 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
9656 }
9657 }
9658
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009659 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
9660 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
9661 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
9662 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009663 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00009664 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009665 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009666
9667 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009668 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
9669 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
9670 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
9671 //
9672 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
9673 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
9674 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
9675
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009676 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009677
9678 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
9679 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
9680 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
9681 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00009682 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009683
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009684 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009685 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00009686 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
9687 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
9688 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009689 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009690 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
9691 Sum = GO1;
9692 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
9693 Sum = SO1;
9694 } else {
9695 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
9696 // target's pointer size.
9697 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
9698 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009699 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009700 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009701 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009702 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009703 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
9704 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009705 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009706 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009707
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009708 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009709 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009710 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009711 } else {
9712 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009713 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
9714 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009715 }
9716 }
9717 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009718 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
9719 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
9720 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009721 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00009722 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009723 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009724 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009725
9726 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
9727 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
9728 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
9729 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
9730 return &GEP;
9731 } else {
9732 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9733 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
9734 Indices.push_back(Sum);
9735 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
9736 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009737 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009738 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009739 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009740 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009741 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9742 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009743 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
9744 }
9745
9746 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009747 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
9748 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009749
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009750 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009751 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
9752 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
9753
9754 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009755 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009756 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
9757 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
9758 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
9759
9760 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009761 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
9762 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009763
9764 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
9765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
9766 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009767 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009768 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
9769 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
9770 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009771 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
9772 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009773 //
9774 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
9775 //
9776 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
9777 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
9778 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
9779 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
9780 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
9781 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
9782 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
9783 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
9784 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
9785 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
9786 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
9787 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
9788 return &GEP;
9789 }
9790 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
9791 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009792 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
9793 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009794 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
9795 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
9796 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009797 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
9798 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009799 Value *Idx[2];
9800 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9801 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009802 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009803 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009804 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
9805 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009806 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009807
9808 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009809 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009810 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009811 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009812
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009813 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009814 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009815 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009816
9817 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
9818 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
9819 Value *NewIdx = 0;
9820 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
9821 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
9822 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
9823 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
9824 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00009825 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009826 Scale = CI;
9827 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
9828 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
9829 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00009830 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9831 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
9832 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009833 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9834 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
9835 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
9836 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9837 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9838 }
9839 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009840
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009841 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009842 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
9843 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
9844 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
9845 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
9846 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
9847 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
9848 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009849 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009850 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009851 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009852 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009853 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
9854 }
9855
9856 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009857 Value *Idx[2];
9858 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9859 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009860 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009861 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009862 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
9863 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
9864 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009865 }
9866 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009867 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009868 }
9869
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009870 return 0;
9871}
9872
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009873Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
9874 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009875 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009876 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9877 const Type *NewTy =
9878 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009879 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009880
9881 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
9882 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009883 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009884 else {
9885 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009886 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009887 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009888
9889 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009890
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009891 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
9892 // allocas if possible...
9893 //
9894 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
9895 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
9896
9897 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
9898 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
9899 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009900 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009901 Value *Idx[2];
9902 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
9903 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009904 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
9905 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009906
9907 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
9908 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009909 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009910 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9911 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009912 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009913 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009914
9915 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
9916 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
9917 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009918 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009919 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009920 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
9921
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009922 return 0;
9923}
9924
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00009925Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
9926 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
9927
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009928 // free undef -> unreachable.
9929 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
9930 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009931 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009932 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009933 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
9934 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00009935
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00009936 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
9937 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009938 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009939 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00009940
9941 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
9942 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
9943 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
9944 return &FI;
9945 }
9946
9947 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
9948 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
9949 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9950 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
9951 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
9952 return &FI;
9953 }
9954 }
9955
9956 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
9957 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
9958 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
9959 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
9960 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
9961 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00009962
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00009963 return 0;
9964}
9965
9966
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009967/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009968static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00009969 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009970 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009971 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009972
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009973 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
9974 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
9975 // directly if string length is small enough.
9976 const std::string &Str = CE->getOperand(0)->getStringValue();
9977 if (!Str.empty()) {
9978 unsigned len = Str.length();
9979 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
9980 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9981 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
9982 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00009983 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
9984 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
9985 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
9986 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
9987 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
9988 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9989 }
9990 } else {
9991 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
9992 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
9993 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9994 }
9995 // Append NULL at the end.
9996 SingleChar = 0;
9997 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9998 }
9999 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10000 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010001 }
10002 }
10003 }
10004
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010005 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010006 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010007 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010008
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010009 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010010 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010011 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10012 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10013 // constants.
10014 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10015 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10016 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010017 Value *Idxs[2];
10018 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10019 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010020 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10021 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10022 }
10023
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010024 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010025 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010026 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10027 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10028 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010029 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10030 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010031
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010032 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10033 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10034 // the result of the loaded value.
10035 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10036 CI->getName(),
10037 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10038 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010039 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010040 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010041 }
10042 }
10043 return 0;
10044}
10045
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010046/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010047/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10048/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10049/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10050static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010051 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10052 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10053
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010054 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010055 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010056 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010057 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010058
10059 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10060 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010061 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10062 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10063 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010064 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10065
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010066 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010067 --BBI;
10068
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010069 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10070 // marked invalid.
10071 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10072 return false;
10073
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010074 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10075 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010076 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010077 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010078 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010079
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010080 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010081 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010082}
10083
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010084/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
10085/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
10086/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
10087/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
10088static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
10089 while (1) {
10090 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
10091 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
10092 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
10093 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
10094 else
10095 return Ptr;
10096 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
10097 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
10098 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
10099 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
10100 } else {
10101 return Ptr;
10102 }
10103 }
10104}
10105
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010106Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10107 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010108
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010109 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010110 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10111 if (KnownAlign >
10112 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10113 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010114 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10115
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010116 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010117 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010118 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010119 return Res;
10120
10121 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10122 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010123
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010124 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
10125 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010126 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
10127 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010128 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
10129 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
10130 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010131 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
10132 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
10133 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010134 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010135
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010136 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10137 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10138 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10139 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10140 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010141 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10142 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10143 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10144 // CFG.
10145 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10146 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10147 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10148 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010149 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010150
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010151 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010152 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010153 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10154 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10155 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010156 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10157 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10158 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010159 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10160 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010161 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010162 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010163
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010164 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10165 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010166 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010167 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010168
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010169 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010170 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010171 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10172 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010173 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010174 if (Constant *V =
10175 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010176 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010177 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10178 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10179 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10180 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10181 // CFG.
10182 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10183 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10184 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10185 }
10186
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010187 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010188 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010189 return Res;
10190 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010191 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010192 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010193
10194 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10195 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
10196 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
10197 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10198 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10199 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10200 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10201 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10202 }
10203 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010204
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010205 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010206 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10207 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10208 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10209 //
10210 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10211 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10212 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10213 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10214 // unconditionally.
10215 //
10216 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10217 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010218 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10219 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010220 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010221 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010222 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010223 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010224 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010225 }
10226
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010227 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10228 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10229 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10230 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10231 return &LI;
10232 }
10233
10234 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10235 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10236 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10237 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10238 return &LI;
10239 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010240 }
10241 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010242 return 0;
10243}
10244
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010245/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010246/// when possible.
10247static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10248 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10249 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10250
10251 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10252 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10253 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10254
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010255 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010256 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10257 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10258 // constants.
10259 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10260 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10261 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010262 Value* Idxs[2];
10263 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10264 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010265 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10266 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10267 }
10268
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010269 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10270 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10271 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010272
10273 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010274 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10275 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010276 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010277 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010278 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10279 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10280 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10281 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10282 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010283 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010284 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010285 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010286 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10287 }
10288 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010289 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010290 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010291 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010292 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010293 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010294 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10295 }
10296 }
10297 }
10298 return 0;
10299}
10300
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010301Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10302 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10303 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10304
10305 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010306 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010307 ++NumCombined;
10308 return 0;
10309 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010310
10311 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10312 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010313 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010314 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10315 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10316 ++NumCombined;
10317 return 0;
10318 }
10319
10320 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10321 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10322 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10323 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10324 ++NumCombined;
10325 return 0;
10326 }
10327 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010328
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010329 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010330 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10331 if (KnownAlign >
10332 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10333 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010334 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10335
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010336 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10337 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10338 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10339 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10340 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10341 --ScanInsts) {
10342 --BBI;
10343
10344 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10345 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
10346 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
10347 ++NumDeadStore;
10348 ++BBI;
10349 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10350 continue;
10351 }
10352 break;
10353 }
10354
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010355 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
10356 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
10357 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
10358 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +000010359 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010360 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10361 ++NumCombined;
10362 return 0;
10363 }
10364 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
10365 // may not be dead.
10366 break;
10367 }
10368
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010369 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000010370 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010371 break;
10372 }
10373
10374
10375 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010376
10377 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
10378 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
10379 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
10380 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
10381 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010382 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010383 ++NumCombined;
10384 }
10385 return 0; // Do not modify these!
10386 }
10387
10388 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
10389 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010390 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010391 ++NumCombined;
10392 return 0;
10393 }
10394
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010395 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
10396 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010397 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010398 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10399 return Res;
10400 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010401 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010402 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10403 return Res;
10404
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010405
10406 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
10407 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010408 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010409 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010410 if (BI->isUnconditional())
10411 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
10412 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010413
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010414 return 0;
10415}
10416
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010417/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
10418/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
10419/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10420///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010421/// Simplify things like:
10422/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
10423/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10424///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010425bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
10426 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
10427
10428 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
10429 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
10430 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010431 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010432
10433 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
10434 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010435 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
10436 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010437 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010438 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010439 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010440 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010441 return false;
10442
10443 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010444 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010445 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010446 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010447 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010448 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010449 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000010450
10451 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
10452 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
10453 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
10454 return false;
10455
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010456 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
10457 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010458 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010459 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010460 return false;
10461
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010462 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
10463 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
10464 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
10465 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
10466 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
10467 --BBI;
10468 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
10469 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10470 return false;
10471 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010472 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010473 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
10474 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
10475 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
10476 return false;
10477
10478 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010479 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
10480 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010481 for (;; --BBI) {
10482 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
10483 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
10484 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10485 return false;
10486 break;
10487 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010488 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
10489 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
10490 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010491 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
10492 return false;
10493 }
10494
10495 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010496 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
10497 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010498 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
10499 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010500 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010501 return false;
10502 }
10503 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010504
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010505 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010506 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
10507 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010508 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010509 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
10510 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010511 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
10512 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010513 }
10514
10515 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
10516 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010517 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010518 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
10519 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
10520
10521 // Nuke the old stores.
10522 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10523 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
10524 ++NumCombined;
10525 return true;
10526}
10527
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010528
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010529Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
10530 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000010531 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010532 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
10533 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
10534 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
10535 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
10536 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10537 BI.setCondition(X);
10538 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10539 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
10540 return &BI;
10541 }
10542
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010543 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
10544 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
10545 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10546 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10547 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
10548 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10549 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010550 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010551 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10552 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010553 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10554 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
10555 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10556 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010557 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010558 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010559 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010560 return &BI;
10561 }
10562
10563 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
10564 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
10565 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10566 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10567 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
10568 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
10569 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10570 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010571 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010572 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10573 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010574 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010575 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010576 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10577 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010578 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010579 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010580 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010581 return &BI;
10582 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010583
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010584 return 0;
10585}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010586
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010587Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
10588 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
10589 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
10590 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
10591 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
10592 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
10593 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010594 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010595 AddRHS));
10596 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010597 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010598 return &SI;
10599 }
10600 }
10601 return 0;
10602}
10603
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010604Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
10605 // See if we are trying to extract a known value. If so, use that instead.
Matthijs Kooijman710eb232008-06-16 12:57:37 +000010606 if (Value *Elt = FindInsertedValue(EV.getOperand(0), EV.idx_begin(),
Matthijs Kooijman0a7413d2008-06-16 13:13:08 +000010607 EV.idx_end(), &EV))
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010608 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Elt);
10609
10610 // No changes
10611 return 0;
10612}
10613
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010614/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
10615/// is to leave as a vector operation.
10616static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
10617 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10618 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010619 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010620 if (isConstant) return true;
10621 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
10622 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
10623 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
10624 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
10625 return false;
10626 return true;
10627 }
10628 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
10629 if (!I) return false;
10630
10631 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
10632 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
10633 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
10634 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
10635 return true;
10636 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
10637 return true;
10638 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
10639 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
10640 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10641 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10642 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010643 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
10644 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
10645 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10646 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10647 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010648
10649 return false;
10650}
10651
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000010652/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
10653///
10654/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
10655/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010656static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
10657 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10658 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10659 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
10660 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10661 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
10662
10663 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010664 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010665 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
10666 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010667 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
10668 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010669 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010670 return Result;
10671}
10672
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010673/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
10674/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
10675/// extracted from the vector.
10676static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010677 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
10678 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010679 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
10680 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010681 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10682
10683 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
10684 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10685 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10686 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010687 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010688 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
10689 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10690 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010691 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
10692 return 0;
10693 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010694
10695 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
10696 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010697 if (EltNo == IIElt)
10698 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010699
10700 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
10701 // vector input.
10702 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010703 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010704 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
10705 if (InEl < Width)
10706 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
10707 else if (InEl < Width*2)
10708 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
10709 else
10710 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010711 }
10712
10713 // Otherwise, we don't know.
10714 return 0;
10715}
10716
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010717Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010718 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010719 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10720 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10721
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010722 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010723 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
10725
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010726 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000010727 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
10728 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
10729 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010730 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010731 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010732 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
10733 op0 = 0;
10734 break;
10735 }
10736 if (op0)
10737 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010738 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010739
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010740 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
10741 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010742 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010743 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
10744 unsigned VectorWidth =
10745 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
10746
10747 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
10748 // crashing the code below.
10749 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
10750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10751
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010752 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
10753 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
10754 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010755 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010756 uint64_t UndefElts;
10757 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010758 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010759 UndefElts)) {
10760 EI.setOperand(0, V);
10761 return &EI;
10762 }
10763 }
10764
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010765 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010766 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000010767
10768 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
10769 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
10770 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
10771 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
10772 if (const VectorType *VT =
10773 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
10774 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
10775 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
10776 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
10777 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010778 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010779
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010780 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010781 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
10782 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
10783 // profitable to do so
10784 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010785 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
10786 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
10787 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
10788 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
10789 EI.getName()+".lhs");
10790 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
10791 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
10792 EI.getName()+".rhs");
10793 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
10794 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010795 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010796 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010797 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010798 unsigned AS =
10799 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000010800 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
10801 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010802 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
10803 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010804 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
10805 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010806 }
10807 }
10808 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
10809 // Extracting the inserted element?
10810 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
10811 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
10812 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
10813 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
10814 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
10815 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10816 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
10817 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
10818 return &EI;
10819 }
10820 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
10821 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
10822 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010823 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10824 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010825 Value *Src;
10826 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
10827 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
10828 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
10829 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10830 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
10831 } else {
10832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000010833 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010834 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010835 }
10836 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010837 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010838 return 0;
10839}
10840
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010841/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
10842/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
10843/// Otherwise, return false.
10844static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
10845 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
10846 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
10847 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010848 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010849
10850 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010851 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010852 return true;
10853 } else if (V == LHS) {
10854 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010855 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010856 return true;
10857 } else if (V == RHS) {
10858 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010859 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010860 return true;
10861 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10862 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
10863 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
10864 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
10865 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
10866
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010867 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
10868 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010869 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010870
10871 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
10872 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
10873 // transitively ok.
10874 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
10875 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010876 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010877 return true;
10878 }
10879 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
10880 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010881 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
10882 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010883 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010884
10885 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
10886 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
10887 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
10888 // transitively ok.
10889 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
10890 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
10891 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
10892 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010893 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010894 } else {
10895 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
10896 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010897 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010898
10899 }
10900 return true;
10901 }
10902 }
10903 }
10904 }
10905 }
10906 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
10907
10908 return false;
10909}
10910
10911/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
10912/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
10913/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010914static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010915 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010916 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010917 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010918 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010919 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010920
10921 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010922 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010923 return V;
10924 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010925 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010926 return V;
10927 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10928 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
10929 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
10930 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
10931 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
10932
10933 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
10934 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
10935 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
10936 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010937 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
10938 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010939
10940 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
10941 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010942 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
10943 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
10944 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010945 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010946 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010947 return V;
10948 }
10949
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010950 if (VecOp == RHS) {
10951 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010952 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
10953 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
10954 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010955 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010956 }
10957 return V;
10958 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010959
10960 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
10961 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
10962 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
10963 return EI->getOperand(0);
10964
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010965 }
10966 }
10967 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010968 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010969
10970 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
10971 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010972 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010973 return V;
10974}
10975
10976Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
10977 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
10978 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
10979 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
10980
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000010981 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
10982 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
10983 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10984
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010985 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
10986 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
10987 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
10988 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
10989 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
10990 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000010991 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
10992 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010993 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010994
10995 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
10996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10997
10998 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
10999 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11000
11001 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11002 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11003 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11004 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11005
11006 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11007 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11008 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11009 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11010 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11011 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11012 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11013 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11014 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11015 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011016 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011017 else {
11018 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011019 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011020 NumVectorElts));
11021 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011022 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011023 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011024 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011025 }
11026
11027 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11028 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11029 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11030 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011031 Value *RHS = 0;
11032 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11033 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11034 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011035 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011036 }
11037 }
11038 }
11039
11040 return 0;
11041}
11042
11043
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011044Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11045 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11046 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011047 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011048
11049 bool MadeChange = false;
11050
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011051 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011052 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011053 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
11054
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011055 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011056 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011057 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
11058 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
11059 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
11060 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11061 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
11062 Mask[i] = 2*e;
11063 MadeChange = true;
11064 }
11065 }
11066
11067 if (MadeChange) {
11068 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11069 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11070 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11071 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
11072 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11073 else
11074 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11075 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011076 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011077 }
11078 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011079
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011080 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11081 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11082 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11083 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011084 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11085 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11086 }
11087
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011088 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11089 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11090 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011091 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011092 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011093 else {
11094 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
11095 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
11096 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
11097 else
11098 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011099 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011100 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011101 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011102 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011103 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011104 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011105 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11106 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011107 MadeChange = true;
11108 }
11109
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011110 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011111 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011112
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011113 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11114 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11115 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11116 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11117
11118 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11119 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011120 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011121
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011122 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11123 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11124 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011125
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011126 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11127 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11128 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11129 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11130 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11131 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11132 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11133 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11134 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11135 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11136 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11137 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11138
11139 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11140 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11141 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11142 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11143 else
11144 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11145
11146 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11147 // the replacement.
11148 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11149 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11150 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11151 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011152 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011153 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011154 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011155 }
11156 }
11157 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11158 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011159 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011160 }
11161 }
11162 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011163
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011164 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11165}
11166
11167
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011168
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011169
11170/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11171/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11172/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11173/// end of its block.
11174static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11175 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11176
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011177 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011178 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11179 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011180
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011181 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011182 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11183 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011184 return false;
11185
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011186 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11187 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011188 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11189 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011190 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11191 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11192 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011193 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011194
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011195 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011196
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011197 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011198 ++NumSunkInst;
11199 return true;
11200}
11201
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011202
11203/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11204/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11205///
11206/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11207/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11208/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11209/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11210/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11211///
11212static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011213 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011214 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011215 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011216 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
11217 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011218
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011219 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11220 BB = Worklist.back();
11221 Worklist.pop_back();
11222
11223 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11224 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11225
11226 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11227 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011228
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011229 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11230 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11231 ++NumDeadInst;
11232 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11233 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11234 continue;
11235 }
11236
11237 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11238 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11239 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11240 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11241 ++NumConstProp;
11242 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11243 continue;
11244 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011245
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011246 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011247 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011248
11249 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11250 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11251 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11252 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11253 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11254 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011255 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011256 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011257 continue;
11258 }
11259 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11260 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11261 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11262 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11263 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011264 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011265 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011266 continue;
11267 }
11268
11269 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11270 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11271 continue;
11272 }
11273 }
11274
11275 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11276 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011277 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011278}
11279
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011280bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011281 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000011282 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011283
11284 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
11285 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011286
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011287 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011288 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
11289 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
11290 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011291 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011292 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000011293
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011294 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
11295 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
11296 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
11297 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
11298 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
11299 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
11300 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
11301 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000011302
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011303 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011304 ++NumDeadInst;
11305
11306 if (!I->use_empty())
11307 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
11308 I->eraseFromParent();
11309 }
11310 }
11311 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011312
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011313 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11314 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
11315 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011316
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011317 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011318 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011319 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011320 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011321 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011322 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011323
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011324 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011325
11326 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011327 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011328 continue;
11329 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011330
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011331 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000011332 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011333 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011334
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011335 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011336 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000011337 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
11338
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011339 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011340 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011341 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011342 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011343 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011344
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000011345 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
11346 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
11347 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
11348 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
11349 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
11350 i->set(NewC);
11351 }
11352 }
11353 }
11354
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011355 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011356 // FIXME: Remove GetResultInst test when first class support for aggregates
11357 // is implemented.
Devang Patelf944c9a2008-05-03 00:36:30 +000011358 if (I->hasOneUse() && !isa<GetResultInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011359 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
11360 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
11361 if (UserParent != BB) {
11362 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
11363 // See if the user is one of our successors.
11364 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
11365 if (*SI == UserParent) {
11366 UserIsSuccessor = true;
11367 break;
11368 }
11369
11370 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
11371 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
11372 // otherwise), we can keep going.
11373 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
11374 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
11375 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
11376 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
11377 }
11378 }
11379
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011380 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011381#ifndef NDEBUG
11382 std::string OrigI;
11383#endif
11384 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011385 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000011386 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011387 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011388 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011389 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
11390 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011391
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011392 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
11393 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
11394
11395 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011396 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011397 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011398
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011399 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
11400 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011401
11402 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
11403 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011404 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
11405
11406 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
11407 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
11408 ++InsertPos;
11409
11410 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011411
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011412 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
11413 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011414 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000011415
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011416 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
11417 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011418 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011419
11420 // Erase the old instruction.
11421 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011422 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011423#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011424 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
11425 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011426#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011427
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011428 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
11429 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011430 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
11431 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
11432 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011433 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011434
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011435 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011436 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011437 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011438 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011439 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011440 AddToWorkList(I);
11441 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011442 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011443 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011444 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011445 }
11446 }
11447
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011448 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000011449
11450 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
11451 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011452 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011453}
11454
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011455
11456bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000011457 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
11458
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011459 bool EverMadeChange = false;
11460
11461 // Iterate while there is work to do.
11462 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000011463 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011464 EverMadeChange = true;
11465 return EverMadeChange;
11466}
11467
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000011468FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011469 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011470}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000011471